Form 10-Q
Table of Contents

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

FORM 10-Q

 

 

QUARTERLY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF

THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the Quarterly Period Ended March 31, 2014

Commission File Number 001-33653

 

 

 

LOGO

(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

 

 

 

Ohio   31-0854434

(State or other jurisdiction

of incorporation or organization)

 

(I.R.S. Employer

Identification Number)

Fifth Third Center

Cincinnati, Ohio 45263

(Address of principal executive offices)

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (800) 972-3030

 

 

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

 

Large accelerated filer   x    Accelerated filer   ¨
Non-accelerated filer   ¨  (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)    Smaller reporting company   ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).    Yes  ¨    No  x

There were 850,512,610 shares of the Registrant’s common stock, without par value, outstanding as of April 30, 2014.

 

 

 


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

FINANCIAL CONTENTS

 

Part I. Financial Information

  

Glossary of Abbreviations and Acronyms

     3   

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (Item 2)

  

Selected Financial Data

     4   

Overview

     5   

Non-GAAP Financial Measures

     9   

Recent Accounting Standards

     11   

Critical Accounting Policies

     11   

Statements of Income Analysis

     12   

Balance Sheet Analysis

     18   

Business Segment Review

     23   

Risk Management—Overview

     29   

Credit Risk Management

     30   

Market Risk Management

     45   

Liquidity Risk Management

     48   

Capital Management

     49   

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

     52   

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk (Item 3)

     53   

Controls and Procedures (Item 4)

     53   

Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes (Item 1)

  

Balance Sheets (unaudited)

     54   

Statements of Income (unaudited)

     55   

Statements of Comprehensive Income (unaudited)

     56   

Statements of Changes in Equity (unaudited)

     57   

Statements of Cash Flows (unaudited)

     58   

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

     59   

Part II. Other Information

  

Legal Proceedings (Item 1)

     107   

Risk Factors (Item 1A)

     107   

Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds (Item 2)

     107   

Exhibits (Item 6)

     107   

Signatures

     108   

Certifications

  

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This report contains statements that we believe are “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and Rule 175 promulgated thereunder, and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and Rule 3b-6 promulgated thereunder. These statements relate to our financial condition, results of operations, plans, objectives, future performance or business. They usually can be identified by the use of forward-looking language such as “will likely result,” “may,” “are expected to,” “is anticipated,” “estimate,” “forecast,” “projected,” “intends to,” or may include other similar words or phrases such as “believes,” “plans,” “trend,” “objective,” “continue,” “remain,” or similar expressions, or future or conditional verbs such as “will,” “would,” “should,” “could,” “might,” “can,” or similar verbs. You should not place undue reliance on these statements, as they are subject to risks and uncertainties, including but not limited to the risk factors set forth in our most recent Annual Report on Form 10-K. When considering these forward-looking statements, you should keep in mind these risks and uncertainties, as well as any cautionary statements we may make. Moreover, you should treat these statements as speaking only as of the date they are made and based only on information then actually known to us. There are a number of important factors that could cause future results to differ materially from historical performance and these forward-looking statements. Factors that might cause such a difference include, but are not limited to: (1) general economic conditions and weakening in the economy, specifically the real estate market, either nationally or in the states in which Fifth Third, one or more acquired entities and/or the combined company do business, are less favorable than expected; (2) deteriorating credit quality; (3) political developments, wars or other hostilities may disrupt or increase volatility in securities markets or other economic conditions; (4) changes in the interest rate environment reduce interest margins; (5) prepayment speeds, loan origination and sale volumes, charge-offs and loan loss provisions; (6) Fifth Third’s ability to maintain required capital levels and adequate sources of funding and liquidity; (7) maintaining capital requirements may limit Fifth Third’s operations and potential growth; (8) changes and trends in capital markets; (9) problems encountered by larger or similar financial institutions may adversely affect the banking industry and/or Fifth Third; (10) competitive pressures among depository institutions increase significantly; (11) effects of critical accounting policies and judgments; (12) changes in accounting policies or procedures as may be required by the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) or other regulatory agencies; (13) legislative or regulatory changes or actions, or significant litigation, adversely affect Fifth Third, one or more acquired entities and/or the combined company or the businesses in which Fifth Third, one or more acquired entities and/or the combined company are engaged, including the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act; (14) ability to maintain favorable ratings from rating agencies; (15) fluctuation of Fifth Third’s stock price; (16) ability to attract and retain key personnel; (17) ability to receive dividends from its subsidiaries; (18) potentially dilutive effect of future acquisitions on current shareholders’ ownership of Fifth Third; (19) effects of accounting or financial results of one or more acquired entities; (20) difficulties from Fifth Third’s investment in, relationship with, and nature of the operations of Vantiv, LLC; (21) loss of income from any sale or potential sale of businesses that could have an adverse effect on Fifth Third’s earnings and future growth; (22) ability to secure confidential information and deliver products and services through the use of computer systems and telecommunications networks; and (23) the impact of reputational risk created by these developments on such matters as business generation and retention, funding and liquidity.

 

2


Table of Contents

Glossary of Abbreviations and Acronyms

 

 

Fifth Third Bancorp provides the following list of abbreviations and acronyms as a tool for the reader that are used in Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, the Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements and the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

ALCO: Asset Liability Management Committee

ALLL: Allowance for Loan and Lease Losses

AOCI: Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income

ARM: Adjustable Rate Mortgage

ATM: Automated Teller Machine

BCBS: Basel Committee on Banking Supervision

BHC: Bank Holding Company

BOLI: Bank Owned Life Insurance

BPO: Broker Price Opinion

bps: Basis points

CCAR: Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review

CD: Certificate of Deposit

CDC: Fifth Third Community Development Corporation

CFPB: United States Consumer Financial Protection Bureau

C&I: Commercial and Industrial

DCF: Discounted Cash Flow

ERISA: Employee Retirement Income Security Act

ERM: Enterprise Risk Management

ERMC: Enterprise Risk Management Committee

EVE: Economic Value of Equity

FASB: Financial Accounting Standards Board

FDIC: Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation

FHLB: Federal Home Loan Bank

FHLMC: Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

FICO: Fair Isaac Corporation (credit rating)

FNMA: Federal National Mortgage Association

FRB: Federal Reserve Bank

FTE: Fully Taxable Equivalent

FTP: Funds Transfer Pricing

FTS: Fifth Third Securities

GNMA: Government National Mortgage Association

GSE: Government Sponsored Enterprise

HAMP: Home Affordable Modification Program

  

HARP: Home Affordable Refinance Program

IPO: Initial Public Offering

IRC: Internal Revenue Code

IRLC: Interest Rate Lock Commitment

ISDA: International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc.

LCR: Liquidity Coverage Ratio

LIBOR: London InterBank Offered Rate

LLC: Limited Liability Company

LTV: Loan-to-Value

MD&A: Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

MSR: Mortgage Servicing Right

N/A: Not Applicable

NII: Net Interest Income

NM: Not Meaningful

NPR: Notice of Proposed Rulemaking

NSFR: Net Stable Funding Ratio

OCC: Office of the Comptroller of the Currency

OCI: Other Comprehensive Income

OREO: Other Real Estate Owned

OTTI: Other-Than-Temporary Impairment

PMI: Private Mortgage Insurance

SBA: Small Business Administration

SEC: United States Securities and Exchange Commission

TBA: To Be Announced

TDR: Troubled Debt Restructuring

TruPS: Trust Preferred Securities

U.S.: United States of America

U.S. GAAP: United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles

VaR: Value-at-Risk

VIE: Variable Interest Entity

VRDN: Variable Rate Demand Note

 

3


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (Item 2)

 

The following is MD&A of certain significant factors that have affected Fifth Third Bancorp’s (the “Bancorp” or “Fifth Third”) financial condition and results of operations during the periods included in the Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, which are a part of this filing. Reference to the Bancorp incorporates the parent holding company and all consolidated subsidiaries.

TABLE 1: Selected Financial Data

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
        

($ in millions, except for per share data)

   2014     2013      % Change  

Income Statement Data

       

Net interest income(a)

   $ 898       893        1  

Noninterest income

     564       743        (24

Total revenue(a)

     1,462       1,636        (11

Provision for loan and lease losses

     69       62        12  

Noninterest expense

     950       978        (3

Net income attributable to Bancorp

     318       422        (25

Net income available to common shareholders

     309       413        (25
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Common Share Data

       

Earnings per share, basic

   $ 0.36       0.47        (23

Earnings per share, diluted

     0.36       0.46        (22

Cash dividends per common share

     0.12       0.11        9  

Book value per share

     16.27       15.42        6  

Market value per share

     22.96       16.31        41  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial Ratios (%)

       

Return on average assets

     1.00      1.41        (29

Return on average common equity

     9.0       12.5        (28

Dividend payout ratio

     33.3       23.4        42  

Average Bancorp shareholders’ equity as a percent of average assets

     11.53       11.38        1  

Tangible common equity(b)

     8.79       9.03        (3

Net interest margin(a)

     3.22       3.42        (6

Efficiency(a)

     64.9       59.8        9  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Credit Quality

       

Net losses charged off

   $ 168       133        26  

Net losses charged off as a percent of average loans and leases(d)

     0.76      0.63        21  

ALLL as a percent of portfolio loans and leases

     1.65       2.08        (21

Allowance for credit losses as a percent of portfolio loans and leases(c)

     1.82       2.28        (20

Nonperforming assets as a percent of portfolio loans, leases and other assets, including other real estate owned(d)

     1.05       1.41        (25
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Average Balances

       

Loans and leases, including held for sale

   $ 90,238       88,880        2  

Total securities and other short-term investments

     22,940       16,846        36  

Total assets

     128,930       121,117        6  

Transaction deposits(e)

     87,896       80,938        9  

Core deposits(f)

     91,512       84,920        8  

Wholesale funding(g)

     18,244       17,683        3  

Bancorp shareholders’ equity

     14,862       13,779        8  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Regulatory Capital Ratios (%)

       

Tier I risk-based capital

     10.45      10.83        (4

Total risk-based capital

     14.02       14.35        (2

Tier I leverage

     9.65       10.03        (4

Tier I common equity(b)

     9.51       9.70        (2
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Amounts presented on an FTE basis. The FTE adjustment for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013 was $5.
(b) The tangible common equity and Tier I common equity ratios are non-GAAP measures. For further information, see the Non-GAAP Financial Measures section of the MD&A.
(c) The allowance for credit losses is the sum of the ALLL and the reserve for unfunded commitments.
(d) Excludes nonaccrual loans held for sale.
(e) Includes demand, interest checking, savings, money market and foreign office deposits.
(f) Includes transaction deposits plus other time deposits.
(g) Includes certificates $100,000 and over, other deposits, federal funds purchased, other short-term borrowings and long-term debt.

 

4


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

OVERVIEW

Fifth Third Bancorp is a diversified financial services company headquartered in Cincinnati, Ohio. At March 31, 2014, the Bancorp had $129.7 billion in assets, operated 17 affiliates with 1,311 full-service Banking Centers, including 104 Bank Mart® locations open seven days a week inside select grocery stores, and 2,614 ATMs in 12 states throughout the Midwestern and Southeastern regions of the U.S. The Bancorp reports on four business segments: Commercial Banking, Branch Banking, Consumer Lending and Investment Advisors. The Bancorp also has a 26% interest in Vantiv Holding, LLC. The carrying value of the Bancorp’s investment in Vantiv Holding, LLC was $437 million as of March 31, 2014.

This overview of MD&A highlights selected information in the financial results of the Bancorp and may not contain all of the information that is important to you. For a more complete understanding of trends, events, commitments, uncertainties, liquidity, capital resources and critical accounting policies and estimates, you should carefully read this entire document as well as the 2013 Form 10-K. Each of these items could have an impact on the Bancorp’s financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. In addition, see the Glossary of Abbreviations and Acronyms in this report for a list of terms included as a tool for the reader of this quarterly report on Form 10-Q. The abbreviations and acronyms identified therein are used throughout this MD&A, as well as the Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

The Bancorp believes that banking is first and foremost a relationship business where the strength of the competition and challenges for growth can vary in every market. The Bancorp believes its affiliate operating model provides a competitive advantage by emphasizing individual relationships. Through its affiliate operating model, individual managers at all levels within the affiliates are given the opportunity to tailor financial solutions for their customers.

Net interest income, net interest margin and the efficiency ratio are presented in MD&A on an FTE basis. The FTE basis adjusts for the tax-favored status of income from certain loans and securities held by the Bancorp that are not taxable for federal income tax purposes. The Bancorp believes this presentation to be the preferred industry measurement of net interest income as it provides a relevant comparison between taxable and non-taxable amounts.

The Bancorp’s revenues are dependent on both net interest income and noninterest income. For the three months ended March 31, 2014, net interest income, on an FTE basis, and noninterest income provided 61% and 39% of total revenue, respectively. The Bancorp derives the majority of its revenues within the U.S. from customers domiciled in the U.S. Revenue from foreign countries and external customers domiciled in foreign countries is immaterial to the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements. Changes in interest rates, credit quality, economic trends and the capital markets are primary factors that drive the performance of the Bancorp. As discussed later in the Risk Management section, risk identification, measurement, monitoring, control and reporting are important to the management of risk and to the financial performance and capital strength of the Bancorp.

Net interest income is the difference between interest income earned on assets such as loans, leases and securities, and interest expense incurred on liabilities such as deposits, short-term borrowings and long-term debt. Net interest income is affected by the general level of interest rates, the relative level of short-term and long-term interest rates, changes in interest rates and changes in the amount and composition of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities. Generally, the rates of interest the Bancorp earns on its assets and pays on its liabilities are established for a period of time. The change in market interest rates over time exposes the Bancorp to interest rate risk through potential adverse changes to net interest income and financial position. The Bancorp manages this risk by continually analyzing and adjusting the composition of its assets and liabilities based on their payment streams and interest rates, the timing of their maturities and their sensitivity to changes in market interest rates. Additionally, in the ordinary course of business, the Bancorp enters into certain derivative transactions as part of its overall strategy to manage its interest rate and prepayment risks. The Bancorp is also exposed to the risk of losses on its loan and lease portfolio, as a result of changing expected cash flows caused by borrower credit events, such as, loan defaults and inadequate collateral due to a weakened economy within the Bancorp’s footprint.

Noninterest income is derived primarily from service charges on deposits, mortgage banking net revenue, corporate banking revenue, investment advisory revenue, card and processing revenue and other noninterest income. Noninterest expense is primarily driven by personnel costs, net occupancy expenses, and technology and communication costs.

Accelerated Share Repurchase Transactions

During 2013 and the three months ended March 31, 2014, the Bancorp entered into a number of accelerated share repurchase transactions. As part of these transactions, the Bancorp entered into forward contracts in which the final number of shares delivered at settlement was based generally on a discount to the average daily volume weighted average price of the Bancorp’s common stock during the term of the repurchase agreements. For more information on the accounting for these instruments, see the Capital Management section of MD&A. For a summary of the Bancorp’s accelerated share repurchase transactions that were entered into or settled during the three months ended March 31, 2014 refer to Table 2.

TABLE 2: Summary of Accelerated Share Repurchase Transactions

 

Repurchase Date

   Amount
($ in millions)
     Shares
Repurchased
     Shares Received from Forward
Contract Settlement
     Total Shares
Repurchased
     Settlement Date  

November 18, 2013

   $ 200        8,538,423        1,132,495        9,670,918        March 5, 2014   

December 13, 2013

     456        19,084,195        2,294,932        21,379,127        March 31, 2014   

January 31, 2014

     99        3,950,705        602,109        4,552,814        March 31, 2014   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

5


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Senior Notes Offering

On February 28, 2014, the Bancorp issued and sold $500 million of 2.30% unsecured senior fixed rate notes, with a maturity of five years, due on March 1, 2019. These notes will be redeemable by the Bancorp, in whole or in part, on or after the date that is 30 days prior to the maturity date at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount plus accrued and unpaid interest up to, but excluding the redemption date.

Automobile Loan Securitization

In February of 2014, the Bancorp transferred approximately $1.3 billion in fixed-rate consumer automobile loans to a bankruptcy remote trust which was deemed to be a VIE. The Bancorp concluded that it is the primary beneficiary of the VIE and, therefore, has consolidated this VIE. For additional information on the automobile loan securitization, refer to Note 8 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

Legislative Developments

On July 21, 2010, the Dodd-Frank Act was signed into federal law. This act implements changes to the financial services industry and affects the lending, deposit, investment, trading and operating activities of financial institutions and their holding companies. The legislation establishes a CFPB responsible for implementing and enforcing compliance with consumer financial laws, changes the methodology for determining deposit insurance assessments, gives the FRB the ability to regulate and limit interchange rates charged to merchants for the use of debit cards, enacts new limitations on proprietary trading, broadens the scope of derivative instruments subject to regulation, requires on-going stress tests and the submission of annual capital plans for certain organizations and requires changes to regulatory capital ratios. This act also calls for federal regulatory agencies to conduct multiple studies over the next several years in order to implement its provisions. While the total impact of the fully implemented Dodd-Frank Act on the Bancorp is not currently known, the impact is expected to be substantial and may have an adverse impact on the Bancorp’s financial performance and growth opportunities.

The FRB launched the 2014 capital planning and stress testing program, CCAR, on November 1, 2013. The CCAR program requires BHCs with $50 billion or more of total consolidated assets to submit annual capital plans to the FRB for review and to conduct stress tests under a number of economic scenarios. The capital plan and stress testing results were submitted by the Bancorp to the FRB on January 6, 2014.

In March of 2014, the FRB disclosed its estimates of participating institutions results under the FRB supervisory stress scenario, including capital results, which assume all banks take certain consistently applied future capital actions. In addition, the FRB disclosed its estimates of participating institutions results under the FRB supervisory severe stress scenarios including capital results based on each company’s own base scenario capital actions.

On March 26, 2014, the Bancorp announced the results of its capital plan submitted to the FRB as part of the 2014 CCAR. The FRB indicated to the Bancorp that it did not object to the following capital actions for the period beginning April 1, 2014 and ending March 31, 2015:

 

   

the potential increase in the quarterly common stock dividend to $0.13 per share;

 

   

the potential repurchase of common shares in an amount up to $669 million;

 

   

and the ability to repurchase shares in the amount of any after-tax gains from the sale of Vantiv, Inc. common stock.

For more information on the 2014 CCAR results, refer to the Capital Management section of MD&A.

The Bancorp and other large bank holding companies are required to conduct a separate mid-year stress test using financial data as of March 31st under three company-derived macro-economic scenarios (base, adverse and severely adverse). The Bancorp will submit the results of its mid-year stress test to the FRB in July of 2014. For further discussion on the 2014 mid-year stress test, see the Capital Management section of MD&A.

Fifth Third offers qualified deposit customers a deposit advance product if they choose to avail themselves of this product to meet short term, small-dollar financial needs. In April of 2013, the CFPB issued a “White Paper” which studied financial services industry offerings and customer use of deposit advance products as well as payday loans and is considering whether rules governing these products are warranted. At the same time, the OCC and FDIC each issued proposed supervisory guidance for public comment to institutions they supervise which supplements existing OCC and FDIC guidance, detailing the principles they expect financial institutions to follow in connection with deposit advance products and supervisory expectations for the use of deposit advance products. The Federal Reserve also issued a statement in April to state member banks like Fifth Third for whom the Federal Reserve is the primary regulator. This statement encouraged state member banks to respond to customers’ small-dollar credit needs in a responsible manner; emphasized that they should take into consideration the risks associated with deposit advance products, including potential consumer harm and potential elevated compliance risk; and reminded them that these product offerings must comply with applicable laws and regulations. Fifth Third’s deposit advance product is designed to fully comply with the applicable federal and state laws and use of this product is subject to strict eligibility requirements and advance restriction guidelines to limit dependency on this product as a borrowing source. Fifth Third believes this product provides customers with a relatively low-cost alternative for such needs. On January 17, 2014, given developments in industry practice, Fifth Third announced that it will no longer enroll new customers in its deposit advance product and will phase out the service to existing customers by the end of 2014. These advance balances are included in other consumer loans and leases in the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets and represent substantially all of the revenue reported in interest and fees on other consumer loans and leases in the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income and in Table 4 in the Statements of Income Analysis section of MD&A. Fifth Third has been monitoring industry developments and is working to develop and implement alternative products and services in order to address the needs of its customers. The Bancorp is currently in the process of evaluating the impact to the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements of both the phase out of the deposit advance product and the development of alternative products and services.

 

6


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

In December of 2010 and revised in June of 2011, the BCBS issued Basel III, a global regulatory framework, to enhance international capital standards. In June of 2012, U.S. banking regulators proposed enhancements to the regulatory capital requirements for U.S. banks, which implement aspects of Basel III, such as re-defining the regulatory capital elements and minimum capital ratios, introducing regulatory capital buffers above those minimums, revising the agencies’ rules for calculating risk-weighted assets and introducing a new Tier I common equity ratio. In July of 2013, U.S. banking regulators approved the final enhanced regulatory capital rules (Basel III Final Rule), which included modifications to the proposed rules. The Bancorp continues to evaluate the Basel III Final Rule and its potential impact. For more information on the impact of the regulatory capital enhancements, refer to the Capital Management section of MD&A. Refer to the Non-GAAP section of MD&A for an estimate of the Basel III Tier 1 common equity ratio.

On December 10, 2013, the banking agencies finalized section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act known as the Volcker Rule, which became effective April 1, 2014. Though the final rule was effective April 1, 2014, the Federal Reserve has granted the industry an extension of time until July 21, 2015 to conform activities to be in compliance with the Volcker Rule. It is possible that additional conformance period extensions could be granted either to the entire industry, or, upon request, to requesting banking organizations on a case-by-case basis. The final rule prohibits banks and bank holding companies from engaging in short-term proprietary trading of certain securities, derivatives, commodity futures and options on these instruments for their own account. The Volcker Rule also restricts banks and their affiliated entities from owning, sponsoring or having certain relationships with private equity and hedge funds, as well as holding certain collateralized loan obligations that are deemed to contain ownership interests. Exemptions are provided for certain activities such as underwriting, market making, hedging, trading in certain government obligations and organizing and offering a hedge fund or private equity fund. Fifth Third does not sponsor any private equity or hedge funds that, under the final rule, it is prohibited from sponsoring. As of March 31, 2014, the Bancorp held no collateralized loan obligations. As of March 31, 2014, the Bancorp had approximately $183 million in interests and approximately $75 million in binding commitments to invest in private equity funds that are affected by the Volcker Rule. It is expected that over time the Bancorp may need to sell or redeem these investments, however no formal plan to sell has been approved as of March 31, 2014. The Bancorp believes it is likely that these investments will be reduced over time in the ordinary course before compliance is required.

On January 7, 2013, the BCBS issued a final international standard for the LCR for large, internationally active banks. In addition, the BCBS plans on introducing the NSFR final standard in the next two years. On October 24, 2013, the U.S. banking agencies issued an NPR that would implement a LCR requirement for U.S. banks that is generally consistent with the international LCR standards for large, internationally active banking organizations, generally those with $250 billion or more in total consolidated assets or $10 billion or more in on-balance sheet foreign exposure, and a Modified LCR for BHCs with at least $50 billion in total consolidated assets that are not internationally active, like Fifth Third. The NPR was open for public comment until January 31, 2014. Refer to the Liquidity Risk Management section in MD&A for further discussion on these ratios.

On July 31, 2013, the U.S. District Court for the District of Columbia issued an order granting summary judgment to the plaintiffs in a case challenging certain provisions of the FRB’s rule concerning electronic debit card transaction fees and network exclusivity arrangements (the “Current Rule”) that were adopted to implement Section 1075 of the Dodd-Frank Act, known as the Durbin Amendment. The Court held that, in adopting the Current Rule, the FRB violated the Durbin Amendment’s provisions concerning which costs are allowed to be taken into account for purposes of setting fees that are reasonable and proportional to the costs incurred by the issuer and therefore the Current Rule’s maximum permissible fees were too high. In addition, the Court held that the Current Rule’s network non-exclusivity provisions concerning unaffiliated payment networks for debit cards also violated the Durbin Amendment. The Court vacated the Current Rule, but stayed its ruling to provide the FRB an opportunity to replace the invalidated portions. The FRB appealed this decision and on March 21, 2014, the D.C. Circuit Court of Appeals reversed the District Court’s grant of summary judgment and remanded the case for further proceedings in accordance with its opinion. If this decision is ultimately overturned and/or the FRB re-issues rules for purposes of implementing the Durbin Amendment in a manner consistent with the District Court decision, the amount of debit card interchange fees the Bancorp would be permitted to charge likely would be reduced. Refer to the Noninterest Income subsection of the Statements of Income Analysis section of MD&A for further information regarding the Bancorp’s debit card interchange revenue.

Earnings Summary

The Bancorp’s net income available to common shareholders for the first quarter of 2014 was $309 million, or $0.36 per diluted share, which was net of $9 million in preferred stock dividends. The Bancorp’s net income available to common shareholders for the first quarter of 2013 was $413 million, or $0.46 per diluted share, which was net of $9 million in preferred stock dividends. Pre-provision net revenue was $507 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to $653 million in the same period in 2013. Pre-provision net revenue is a non-GAAP measure. For further information, see the Non-GAAP Financial Measures section in MD&A.

Net interest income was $898 million for the quarter ended March 31, 2014 compared to $893 million for the first quarter of 2013. Net interest income was positively impacted by increases in average taxable securities of $5.2 billion and average loans and leases of $1.4 billion, as well as a decrease in rates paid on long-term debt compared to the same period in the prior year. These benefits were partially offset by lower yields on the Bancorp’s interest-earning assets and an increase in average long-term debt of $2.8 billion. Net interest margin was 3.22% and 3.42% for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

Noninterest income decreased $179 million in the first quarter of 2014 compared to the same period in the prior year. The decrease from the first quarter of 2013 was primarily due to a decrease in mortgage banking net revenue and other noninterest income. Mortgage banking net revenue decreased $111 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in the prior year primarily due to a decrease in origination fees and gains on loan sales and a decrease in positive net valuation adjustments on mortgage servicing rights and free-standing derivatives entered into to economically hedge the MSR portfolio partially offset by a decrease in mortgage servicing rights amortization. Other noninterest income decreased $68 million in the first quarter of 2014 compared to the first quarter of 2013 primarily due to a negative valuation adjustment of $36 million on the stock warrant associated with Vantiv Holding, LLC for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to a positive valuation adjustment of $34 million for the three months ended March 31, 2013.

 

7


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Noninterest expense decreased $28 million in the first quarter of 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 primarily due to a decrease in total personnel costs partially offset by an increase in other noninterest expense. Total personnel costs decreased $53 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013 primarily due to decreases in incentive compensation, base compensation, and employee benefits. Other noninterest expense increased $18 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 primarily due to an increase in litigation expense and an increase in impairment on affordable housing investments partially offset by a decrease in the provision for representation and warranty claims, FDIC insurance and other taxes, and loan and lease expenses.

Credit Summary

The Bancorp does not originate subprime mortgage loans and does not hold asset-backed securities backed by subprime mortgage loans in its securities portfolio. However, the Bancorp has exposure to disruptions in the capital markets and weakened economic conditions. The provision for loan and lease losses was $69 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to $62 million during the same period in 2013. The increase in provision expense compared to the same period in the prior year was due to an increase in certain impaired commercial loans partially offset by improved delinquency metrics. In addition, net charge-offs as a percent of average portfolio loans and leases were 0.76% during the first quarter of 2014 compared to 0.63% during the first quarter of 2013. At March 31, 2014, nonperforming assets as a percent of portfolio loans, leases and other assets, including OREO (excluding nonaccrual loans held for sale) were 1.05%, compared to 1.10% at December 31, 2013. For further discussion on credit quality, see the Credit Risk Management section in MD&A.

Capital Summary

The Bancorp’s capital ratios exceed the “well-capitalized” guidelines as defined by the FRB. As of March 31, 2014, the Tier I risk-based capital ratio was 10.45%, the Tier I leverage ratio was 9.65% and the total risk-based capital ratio was 14.02%.

 

8


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

NON-GAAP FINANCIAL MEASURES

The Bancorp considers various measures when evaluating capital utilization and adequacy, including the tangible equity ratio, tangible common equity ratio and Tier I common equity ratio, in addition to capital ratios defined by banking regulators. These calculations are intended to complement the capital ratios defined by banking regulators for both absolute and comparative purposes. Because U.S. GAAP does not include capital ratio measures, the Bancorp believes there are no comparable U.S. GAAP financial measures to these ratios. These ratios are not formally defined by U.S. GAAP or codified in the federal banking regulations and, therefore, are considered to be non-GAAP financial measures. Since analysts and banking regulators may assess the Bancorp’s capital adequacy using these ratios, the Bancorp believes they are useful to provide investors the ability to assess its capital adequacy on the same basis.

The Bancorp believes these non-GAAP measures are important because they reflect the level of capital available to withstand unexpected market conditions. Additionally, presentation of these measures allows readers to compare certain aspects of the Bancorp’s capitalization to other organizations. However, because there are no standardized definitions for these ratios, the Bancorp’s calculations may not be comparable with other organizations, and the usefulness of these measures to investors may be limited. As a result, the Bancorp encourages readers to consider its Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements in their entirety and not to rely on any single financial measure.

U.S. banking regulators approved final capital rules (Basel III Final Rule) in July of 2013 that substantially amend the existing risk-based capital rules (Basel I) for banks. The Bancorp believes providing an estimate of its capital position based upon the final rules is important to complement the existing capital ratios and for comparability to other financial institutions. Since these rules are not effective for the Bancorp until January 1, 2015, they are considered non-GAAP measures and therefore are included in the following non-GAAP financial measures table.

Pre-provision net revenue is net interest income plus noninterest income minus noninterest expense. The Bancorp believes this measure is important because it provides a ready view of the Bancorp’s earnings before the impact of provision expense.

 

9


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

The following table reconciles non-GAAP financial measures to U.S. GAAP as of or for three months ended:

TABLE 3: Non-GAAP Financial Measures

 

     March 31,     March 31,  

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Income before income taxes (U.S. GAAP)

   $ 438       591  

Add: Provision expense (U.S. GAAP)

     69       62  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Pre-provision net revenue

     507       653  

Net income available to common shareholders (U.S. GAAP)

   $ 309       413  

Add: Intangible amortization, net of tax

     1       1  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tangible net income available to common shareholders

   $ 310       414  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     March 31,     December 31,  
   2014     2013  

Total Bancorp shareholders’ equity (U.S. GAAP)

   $ 14,826       14,589  

Less: Preferred stock

     (1,034     (1,034

Goodwill

     (2,416     (2,416

Intangible assets

     (18     (19
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tangible common equity, including unrealized gains / losses

     11,358       11,120  

Less: Accumulated other comprehensive income

     (196     (82
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tangible common equity, excluding unrealized gains / losses (1)

     11,162       11,038  

Add: Preferred stock

     1,034       1,034  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tangible equity (2)

   $ 12,196       12,072  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets (U.S. GAAP)

   $ 129,654       130,443  

Less: Goodwill

     (2,416     (2,416

Intangible assets

     (18     (19

Accumulated other comprehensive income, before tax

     (302     (126
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tangible assets, excluding unrealized gains / losses (3)

   $ 126,918       127,882  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Bancorp shareholders’ equity (U.S. GAAP)

   $ 14,826       14,589  

Less: Goodwill and certain other intangibles

     (2,490     (2,492

Accumulated other comprehensive income

     (196     (82

Add: Qualifying TruPS

     60       60  

Other

     (18     19  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tier I risk-based capital

     12,182       12,094  

Less: Preferred stock

     (1,034     (1,034

Qualifying TruPS

     (60     (60

Qualified noncontrolling interests in consolidated subsidiaries

     (1     (37
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tier I common equity (4)

   $ 11,087       10,963  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Risk-weighted assets (5) (a)

     $116,622       116,736  

Ratios:

    

Tangible equity (2) / (3)

     9.61      9.44  

Tangible common equity (1) / (3)

     8.79      8.63  

Tier I common equity (4) / (5)

     9.51      9.39  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basel III Final Rule—Estimated Tier I common equity ratio

    

Tier I common equity (Basel I)

   $ 11,087       10,963  

Add: Adjustment related to capital components(b)

     99       82  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Estimated Tier I common equity under Basel III Final Rule without AOCI (opt out) (6)

     11,186       11,045  

Add: Adjustment related to AOCI(c)

     196       82  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Estimated Tier I common equity under Basel III Final Rule with AOCI (non opt out) (7)

     11,382       11,127  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Estimated risk-weighted assets under Basel III Final Rule (d) (8)

     122,659       122,851  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Estimated Tier I common equity ratio under Basel III Final Rule (opt out) (6) / (8)

     9.12      8.99  

Estimated Tier I common equity ratio under Basel III Final Rule (non opt out) (7) / (8)

     9.28      9.06  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Under the banking agencies’ risk-based capital guidelines, assets and credit equivalent amounts of derivatives and off-balance sheet exposures are assigned to broad risk categories. The aggregate dollar amount in each risk category is multiplied by the associated risk weight of the category. The resulting weighted values are added together, along with the measure for market risk, resulting in the Bancorp’s total risk-weighted assets.
(b) Adjustments related to capital components include MSRs and deferred tax assets subject to threshold limitations and deferred tax liabilities related to intangible assets, which were deductions to capital under Basel I capital rules.
(c) Under final Basel III rules, non-advanced approach banks are permitted to make a one-time election to opt out of the requirement to include AOCI in Tier I common equity.
(d) Key differences under Basel III in the calculation of risk-weighted assets compared to Basel I include: (1) Risk weighting for commitments under 1 year; (2) Higher risk weighting for exposures to securitizations, past due loans, foreign banks and certain commercial real estate; (3) Higher risk weighting for MSRs and deferred tax assets that are under certain thresholds as a percent of Tier I capital; and (4) Derivatives are differentiated between exchange clearing and over-the-counter and the 50% risk-weight cap is removed.

 

10


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

RECENT ACCOUNTING STANDARDS

Note 3 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements provides a discussion of the significant new accounting standards applicable to the Bancorp and the expected impact of significant accounting standards issued, but not yet required to be adopted.

CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES

The Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements are prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP. Certain accounting policies require management to exercise judgment in determining methodologies, economic assumptions and estimates that may materially affect the Bancorp’s financial position, results of operations and cash flows. The Bancorp’s critical accounting policies include the accounting for the ALLL, reserve for unfunded commitments, income taxes, valuation of servicing rights, fair value measurements and goodwill. These accounting policies are discussed in detail in Management’s Discussion and Analysis – Critical Accounting Policies in the Bancorp’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013. No material changes were made to the valuation techniques or models during the three months ended March 31, 2014.

 

11


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

STATEMENTS OF INCOME ANALYSIS

Net Interest Income

Net interest income is the interest earned on securities, loans and leases (including yield-related fees) and other interest-earning assets less the interest paid for core deposits (includes transaction deposits and other time deposits) and wholesale funding (includes certificates of deposit $100,000 and over, other deposits, federal funds purchased, other short-term borrowings and long-term debt). The net interest margin is calculated by dividing net interest income by average interest-earning assets. Net interest rate spread is the difference between the average yield earned on interest-earning assets and the average rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities. Net interest margin is typically greater than net interest rate spread due to the interest income earned on those assets that are funded by noninterest-bearing liabilities, or free funding, such as demand deposits or shareholders’ equity.

Table 4 presents the components of net interest income, net interest margin and net interest rate spread for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, as well as the relative impact of changes in the balance sheet and changes in interest rates on net interest income. Nonaccrual loans and leases and loans held for sale have been included in the average loan and lease balances. Average outstanding securities balances are based on amortized cost with any unrealized gains or losses on available-for-sale securities included in other assets.

Net interest income was $898 million for the first quarter of 2014, an increase of $5 million compared to the first quarter of 2013. For the three months ended March 31, 2014, net interest income was positively impacted by increases in average taxable securities of $5.2 billion and average loans and leases of $1.4 billion, as well as a decrease in rates paid on long-term debt compared to the same period in the prior year. These benefits were partially offset by lower yields on the Bancorp’s interest-earning assets and an increase in average long-term debt of $2.8 billion. The net interest rate spread decreased to 3.07% in the first quarter of 2014 from 3.25% in the same period in 2013, as the benefit of the decrease in rates on average interest-bearing liabilities was more than offset by a 26 bps decrease in yield on average interest-earnings assets.

Net interest margin was 3.22% for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to 3.42% for the three months ended March 31, 2013. The decrease of 20 bps was driven primarily by a decline in yields on loans partially offset by an increase in free funding balances and lower rates on interest-bearing liabilities.

Interest income from loans and leases decreased $59 million, or seven percent, compared to the first quarter of 2013. The decrease from the three months ended March 31, 2013 was primarily the result of a decrease of 32 bps in average loans and leases yields partially offset by an increase of two percent in average loans and leases. The increase in average loans and leases for the three months ended March 31, 2014 was driven primarily by an increase of $4.0 billion, or 11%, in average commercial and industrial loans partially offset by a decrease of $1.6 billion, or 11%, in average residential mortgage loans. For more information on the Bancorp’s loan and lease portfolio, see the Loans and Leases section of the Balance Sheet Analysis section of MD&A. In addition, interest income from investment securities and other short-term investments increased $57 million compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013, primarily as the result of an increase of $5.2 billion, or 34%, in average taxable securities coupled with a 35 bps increase in yields on average taxable securities.

Average core deposits increased $6.6 billion, or eight percent, compared to the first quarter of 2013. The increase was primarily due to an increase in average money market deposits, average interest checking deposits and average demand deposits partially offset by a decrease in average savings deposits. The cost of average core deposits decreased to 18 bps for the three months ended March 31, 2014 from 19 bps for the three months ended March 31, 2013. This decrease was primarily the result of a mix shift to lower cost core deposits as a result of run-off of higher priced CDs partially offset by an increase of 4 bps in the rate paid on average money market deposits compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013.

For the three months ended March 31, 2014, interest expense on average wholesale funding decreased $4 million, or seven percent, compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013, primarily as a result of a decrease in interest expense related to long-term debt and a $3.6 billion decrease in average other short-term borrowings coupled with an 8 bps decrease in the rate paid for other short-term borrowings. Interest expense on long-term debt decreased due to a decrease in the rate paid on long-term debt of 90 bps partially offset by a $2.8 billion increase in average long-term debt. Refer to the Borrowings section of the Balance Sheet Analysis section of MD&A for additional information on the Bancorp’s borrowings. During the three months ended March 31, 2014, average wholesale funding represented 23% of average interest-bearing liabilities compared to 24% during the three months ended March 31, 2013. For more information on the Bancorp’s interest rate risk management, including estimated earnings sensitivity to changes in market interest rates, see the Market Risk Management section of MD&A.

 

12


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

TABLE 4: Condensed Average Balance Sheets and Analysis of Net Interest Income

 

For the three months ended

   March 31, 2014     March 31, 2013     Attribution of Change in
Net Interest Income(a)
 

($ in millions)

   Average
Balance
    Revenue/
Cost
     Average
Yield/
Rate
    Average
Balance
    Revenue/
Cost
     Average
Yield/
Rate
    Volume     Yield/Rate     Total  

Assets

                    

Interest-earning assets:

                    

Loans and leases:(b)

                    

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 40,409     $ 334        3.35    $ 36,423     $ 350        3.90    $ 36       (52     (16

Commercial mortgage

     7,983       67        3.43       8,978       80        3.63       (9     (4     (13

Commercial construction

     1,118       10        3.48       700       6        3.21       3       1       4  

Commercial leases

     3,607       27        3.09       3,557       30        3.38       —         (3     (3
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal – commercial

     53,117       438        3.35       49,658       466        3.80       30       (58     (28

Residential mortgage loans

     13,304       129        3.94       14,866       146        3.98       (16     (1     (17

Home equity

     9,194       85        3.74       9,872       91        3.74       (6     —         (6

Automobile loans

     12,023       85        2.86       12,096       98        3.29       (1     (12     (13

Credit card

     2,230       54        9.90       2,069       49        9.67       4       1       5  

Other consumer loans/leases

     370       36        39.93       319       36        46.77       6       (6     —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal – consumer

     37,121       389        4.26       39,222       420        4.35       (13     (18     (31
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total loans and leases

     90,238       827        3.72       88,880       886        4.04       17       (76     (59

Securities:

                    

Taxable

     20,385       168        3.33       15,224       112        2.98       42       14       56  

Exempt from income taxes(b)

     46       1        5.51       51       1        5.44       —         —         —    

Other short-term investments

     2,509       2        0.26       1,571       1        0.26       1       —         1  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest-earning assets

     113,178       998        3.58       105,726       1,000        3.84       60       (62     (2

Cash and due from banks

     2,850            2,225             

Other assets

     14,478            15,016             

Allowance for loan and lease losses

     (1,576          (1,850           
  

 

 

        

 

 

            

Total assets

   $ 128,930          $ 121,117             
  

 

 

        

 

 

            

Liabilities and Equity

                    

Interest-bearing liabilities:

                    

Interest checking

   $ 25,911     $ 14        0.23    $ 23,763     $ 13        0.23    $ —         1       1  

Savings

     16,903       5        0.11       19,576       6        0.13       —         (1     (1

Money market

     12,439       9        0.28       7,932       5        0.24       3       1       4  

Foreign office deposits

     2,017       1        0.29       1,102       1        0.26       —         —         —    

Other time deposits

     3,616       9        0.99       3,982       15        1.50       (1     (5     (6

Certificates - $100,000 and over

     5,576       10        0.70       4,017       11        1.09       4       (5     (1

Other deposits

     —         —          0.05       40       —          0.13       —         —         —    

Federal funds purchased

     547       —          0.10       691       —          0.14       —         —         —    

Other short-term borrowings

     1,808       1        0.10       5,429       2        0.18       —         (1     (1

Long-term debt

     10,313       51        2.04       7,506       54        2.94       16       (19     (3
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing liabilities

     79,130       100        0.51       74,038       107        0.59       22       (29     (7

Demand deposits

     30,626            28,565             

Other liabilities

     4,274            4,687             
  

 

 

        

 

 

            

Total liabilities

     114,030            107,290             

Total equity

     14,900            13,827             
  

 

 

        

 

 

            

Total liabilities and equity

   $ 128,930          $ 121,117             
  

 

 

        

 

 

            

Net interest income

     $ 898          $ 893        $ 38       (33     5  

Net interest margin

          3.22           3.42       

Net interest rate spread

          3.07            3.25        

Interest-bearing liabilities to interest-earning assets

  

     69.92            70.03        
       

 

 

        

 

 

       

 

(a) Changes in interest not solely due to volume or yield/rate are allocated in proportion to the absolute dollar amount of change in volume and yield/rate.
(b) The FTE adjustments included in the above table were $5 for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013.

Provision for Loan and Lease Losses

The Bancorp provides as an expense an amount for probable loan and lease losses within the loan and lease portfolio that is based on factors previously discussed in the Critical Accounting Policies section of the Bancorp’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013. The provision is recorded to bring the ALLL to a level deemed appropriate by the Bancorp to cover losses inherent in the portfolio. Actual credit losses on loans and leases are charged against the ALLL. The amount of loans and leases actually removed from the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets is referred to as charge-offs. Net charge-offs include current period charge-offs less recoveries on previously charged-off loans and leases.

The provision for loan and lease losses was $69 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to $62 million during the same period in 2013. The increase in provision expense compared to the same period in the prior year was due to an increase in certain impaired commercial loans partially offset by improved delinquency metrics. The ALLL declined $99 million from $1.6 billion at December 31, 2013 to $1.5 billion at March 31, 2014. As of March 31, 2014, the ALLL as a percent of portfolio loans and leases decreased to 1.65%, compared to 1.79% at December 31, 2013.

 

13


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Refer to the Credit Risk Management section of the MD&A as well as Note 6 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements for more detailed information on the provision for loan and lease losses, including an analysis of loan portfolio composition, nonperforming assets, net charge-offs, and other factors considered by the Bancorp in assessing the credit quality of the loan and lease portfolio and the ALLL.

Noninterest Income

Noninterest income decreased $179 million, or 24%, for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013.

The components of noninterest income are as follows:

TABLE 5: Noninterest Income

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
        

($ in millions)

   2014      2013      % Change  

Service charges on deposits

   $ 133        131        2  

Mortgage banking net revenue

     109        220        (50

Corporate banking revenue

     104        99        6  

Investment advisory revenue

     102        100        2  

Card and processing revenue

     68        65        5  

Other noninterest income

     41        109        (63

Securities gains, net

     7        17        (60

Securities gains, net - non-qualifying hedges on mortgage servicing rights

     —          2        (100
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total noninterest income

   $ 564        743        (24
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Service charges on deposits

Service charges on deposits increased $2 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in the prior year. The increase for the three months ended March 31, 2014 was primarily driven by commercial deposit revenue which increased $3 million due to new customer acquisition and product expansion. The increase in commercial deposit revenue was partially offset by a $1 million decrease in consumer deposit revenue due to a decrease in consumer overdraft fees.

Mortgage banking net revenue

Mortgage banking net revenue decreased $111 million, or 50%, for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013.

The components of mortgage banking net revenue are as follows:

TABLE 6: Components of Mortgage Banking Net Revenue

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Origination fees and gains on loan sales

   $ 41       169  

Net mortgage servicing revenue:

    

Gross mortgage servicing fees

     62       61  

Mortgage servicing rights amortization

     (22     (53

Net valuation adjustments on mortgage servicing rights and free-standing derivatives entered into to economically hedge MSR

     28       43  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net mortgage servicing revenue

     68       51  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Mortgage banking net revenue

   $ 109       220  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Origination fees and gains on loan sales decreased $128 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013, primarily due to a 76% decrease in residential mortgage loan originations coupled with a decrease in profit margins on sold residential mortgage loans. Residential mortgage loan originations decreased to $1.7 billion during the first quarter of 2014 compared to $7.4 billion during the first quarter of 2013 as fewer borrowers were able to achieve savings refinancing their mortgages.

Net servicing revenue is comprised of gross servicing fees and related servicing rights amortization as well as valuation adjustments on MSRs and mark-to-market adjustments on both settled and outstanding free-standing derivative financial instruments used to economically hedge the MSR portfolio. Net servicing revenue increased $17 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013, driven primarily by a $31 million decrease in servicing rights amortization for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013 due to an increase in interest rates which caused prepayment speeds to slow. The decrease in mortgage servicing rights amortization was partially offset by a $15 million decrease in net valuation adjustments.

 

14


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

The net valuation adjustment of $28 million during the first quarter of 2014 included $24 million in gains from derivatives economically hedging the MSRs and a $4 million recovery of temporary impairment on the MSRs. Actual prepayments on the servicing portfolio continued to decline during the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013. This caused modeled prepayment speeds to slow, which led to the recovery of temporary impairment on servicing rights during the quarter ended March 31, 2014. The net valuation adjustment of $43 million during the first quarter of 2013 included a $49 million recovery of temporary impairment on the MSRs partially offset by $6 million in losses from derivatives economically hedging the MSRs. The Bancorp’s total residential loans serviced as of March 31, 2014 and 2013 were $82.2 billion and $79.5 billion, respectively, with $68.9 billion and $64.8 billion, respectively, of residential mortgage loans serviced for others.

Servicing rights are deemed impaired when a borrower’s loan rate is distinctly higher than prevailing rates. Impairment on servicing rights is reversed when the prevailing rates return to a level commensurate with the borrower’s loan rate. Further detail on the valuation of MSRs can be found in Note 9 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements. The Bancorp maintains a non-qualifying hedging strategy to manage a portion of the risk associated with changes in the valuation on the MSR portfolio. See Note 10 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements for more information on the free-standing derivatives used to economically hedge the MSR portfolio.

In addition to the derivative positions used to economically hedge the MSR portfolio, the Bancorp acquires various securities as a component of its non-qualifying hedging strategy. There were no gains or losses recognized during the three months ended March 31, 2014 and the Bancorp recognized net gains of $2 million during the three months ended March 31, 2013.

Corporate banking revenue

Corporate banking revenue increased $5 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013. The increase compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013 was primarily due to an increase in syndication fees and lease remarketing fees partially offset by a decrease in foreign exchange fees and interest rate derivatives.

Investment advisory revenue

Investment advisory revenue increased $2 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013, primarily driven by a $3 million increase in private client service fees partially offset by a $2 million decrease in securities and brokerage fees due to a decrease in equity market values. The Bancorp had approximately $302 billion and $318 billion in total assets under care as of March 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and managed $26 billion and $27 billion in assets, respectively, for individuals, corporations and not-for-profit organizations for the same comparative periods.

Card and processing revenue

Card and processing revenue increased $3 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013. The increase was the result of higher processing fees related to additional ATM locations and an increase in the number of actively used cards. Debit card interchange revenue, included in card and processing revenue, was $30 million and $29 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

Other noninterest income

The major components of other noninterest income are as follows:

TABLE 7: Components of Other Noninterest Income

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Operating lease income

   $ 21       16  

Equity method income from interest in Vantiv Holding, LLC

     14       17  

Cardholder fees

     11       11  

BOLI income

     11       10  

Banking center income

     8       9  

Consumer loan and lease fees

     6       6  

Insurance income

     3       8  

Gain (loss) on swap associated with the sale of Visa, Inc. class B shares

     1       (7

Gain on loan sales

     —         2  

Loss on OREO

     (10     (10

Valuation adjustments on stock warrant associated with Vantiv Holding, LLC

     (36     34  

Other, net

     12       13  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other noninterest income

   $ 41       109  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other noninterest income decreased $68 million, or 63%, in the first quarter of 2014 compared to the first quarter of 2013 primarily due to valuation adjustments on the stock warrant associated with Vantiv Holding, LLC. The fair value of the stock warrant is calculated using the Black-Scholes valuation model, which utilizes several key inputs (Vantiv Inc. stock price, strike price per the warrant and several unobservable inputs). The negative valuation adjustment of $36 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 was primarily due to a decline of seven percent in Vantiv Inc.’s share price from December 31, 2013 to March 31, 2014. The positive valuation adjustment of $34 million for the three months ended March 31, 2013 was primarily due to an increase of 16% in Vantiv Inc.’s share price from December 31, 2012 to March 31, 2013. For additional information on the valuation of the warrant, see Note 19 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

15


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Noninterest Expense

Total noninterest expense decreased $28 million, or three percent, for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013.

The major components of noninterest expense are as follows:

TABLE 8: Noninterest Expense

 

      For the three months
ended March 31,
       

($ in millions)

   2014     2013     % Change  

Salaries, wages and incentives

   $ 359       399       (10

Employee benefits

     101       114       (11

Net occupancy expense

     80       79       1  

Technology and communications

     53       49       8  

Card and processing expense

     31       31       —    

Equipment expense

     30       28       6  

Other noninterest expense

     296       278       6  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total noninterest expense

   $ 950       978       (3
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Efficiency ratio

     64.9      59.8   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total personnel costs (salaries, wages and incentives plus employee benefits) decreased $53 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013, primarily due to a decrease in incentive compensation driven by the mortgage business which had lower production levels and a decrease in base compensation and employee benefits as a result of a decline in the number of full time equivalent employees. Full time equivalent employees totaled 19,080 at March 31, 2014 compared to 20,744 at March 31, 2013.

TABLE 9: Components of Other Noninterest Expense

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Losses and adjustments

   $ 65       38  

Affordable housing investments impairment

     32       20  

Loan and lease

     29       40  

FDIC insurance and other taxes

     28       34  

Marketing

     22       26  

Professional service fees

     18       14  

Operating lease

     17       12  

Travel

     12       13  

Postal and courier

     12       13  

Data processing

     9       11  

Recruitment and education

     7       6  

OREO expense

     5       4  

Insurance

     4       5  

Intangible asset amortization

     1       2  

Benefit from the reserve for unfunded commitments and letters of credit

     (9     (11

Other, net

     44       51  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other noninterest expense

   $ 296       278  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other noninterest expense increased $18 million, or six percent, for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013. Losses and adjustments increased $27 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 primarily due to an increase in litigation expense partially offset by a decrease in representation and warranty expense. Litigation expense increased $49 million during the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in the prior year due to increased litigation and regulatory activity. The provision for representation and warranty claims decreased $15 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 due to improving underlying repurchase metrics and the settlement in the fourth quarter of 2013 with FHLMC. Impairment on affordable housing investments increased $12 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013, as the prior period included a $9 million benefit from the sale of affordable housing investments. These impacts were partially offset by a decrease in loan and lease expense and FDIC insurance and other taxes. Loan and lease expenses decreased $11 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 primarily as a result of decreases in loan closing fees and appraisal fees due to a decline in mortgage originations. FDIC insurance and other taxes decreased $6 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 due to the improved credit quality of loans which is a component of the FDIC assessment rate calculation.

The Bancorp continues to focus on efficiency initiatives as part of its core emphasis on operating leverage and expense control. The efficiency ratio (noninterest expense divided by the sum of net interest income (FTE) and noninterest income) was 64.9% for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to 59.8% for the three months ended March 31, 2013.

 

16


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Applicable Income Taxes

The Bancorp’s income before income taxes, applicable income tax expense and effective tax rate are as follows:

TABLE 10: Applicable Income Taxes

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Income before income taxes

   $ 438       591  

Applicable income tax expense

     119       179  

Effective tax rate

     27.3      30.4  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Applicable income tax expense for all periods includes the benefit from tax-exempt income, tax-advantaged investments, and tax credits, partially offset by the effect of certain nondeductible expenses. The tax credits are associated with the Low-Income Housing Tax Credit program established under Section 42 of the IRC, the New Markets Tax Credit program established under Section 45D of the IRC, the Rehabilitation Investment Tax Credit program established under Section 47 of the IRC, and the Qualified Zone Academy Bond program established under Section 1397E of the IRC.

As required under U.S. GAAP, the Bancorp established a deferred tax asset for stock-based awards granted to its employees and directors. When the actual tax deduction for these stock-based awards is less than the expense previously recognized for financial reporting or when the awards expire unexercised, the Bancorp is required to write-off the deferred tax asset previously established for these stock-based awards. The stock-based awards granted in March of 2003 had an exercise period that expired in March of 2013. As these stock-based awards were not exercised on or before their expiration date, the Bancorp was required to write-off the $12 million deferred tax asset established for these awards during the first quarter of 2013. Based on the Bancorp’s stock price at March 31, 2014, the Bancorp does not believe it will need to recognize a non-cash charge to income tax expense over the next twelve months related to stock-based awards. However, the Bancorp cannot predict its stock price or whether its employees will exercise other stock-based awards with lower exercise prices in the future. Therefore, it is possible the Bancorp may need to recognize a non-cash charge to income tax expense in the future.

 

17


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

BALANCE SHEET ANALYSIS

Loans and Leases

The Bancorp classifies loans and leases based upon their primary purpose. Table 11 summarizes end of period loans and leases, including loans held for sale and Table 12 summarizes average total loans and leases, including loans held for sale.

TABLE 11: Components of Total Loans and Leases (includes held for sale)

 

     March 31, 2014      December 31, 2013  

($ in millions)

   Balance      % of Total      Balance      % of Total  

Commercial:

           

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 40,692        46        39,347        45  

Commercial mortgage loans

     7,959        9        8,069        9  

Commercial construction loans

     1,220        1        1,041        1  

Commercial leases

     3,577        4        3,626        4  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Subtotal – commercial

     53,448        60        52,083        59  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Consumer:

           

Residential mortgage loans

     13,275        15        13,570        15  

Home equity

     9,125        10        9,246        10  

Automobile loans

     12,088        13        11,984        13  

Credit card

     2,177        2        2,294        3  

Other consumer loans and leases

     372        —          381        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Subtotal – consumer

     37,037        40        37,475        41  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total loans and leases

   $ 90,485        100        89,558        100  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total portfolio loans and leases (excludes loans held for sale)

   $ 89,705           88,614     
  

 

 

       

 

 

    

Loans and leases, including loans held for sale, increased $927 million from December 31, 2013. The increase from December 31, 2013 was the result of a $1.4 billion, or three percent, increase in commercial loans and leases partially offset by a $438 million, or one percent, decrease in consumer loans and leases.

Commercial loans and leases increased from December 31, 2013 primarily due to an increase in commercial and industrial loans and commercial construction loans partially offset by a decrease in commercial mortgage loans. Commercial and industrial loans increased $1.3 billion, or three percent, from December 31, 2013 and commercial construction loans increased $179 million, or 17%, from December 31, 2013 as a result of an increase in new loan origination activity from an increase in demand due to a strengthening economy and targeted marketing efforts. Commercial mortgage loans decreased $110 million, or one percent, from December 31, 2013 due to continued runoff as the level of new originations was less than the repayments of the existing portfolio.

Consumer loans and leases decreased from December 31, 2013 primarily due to a decrease in residential mortgage loans, home equity and credit card loans partially offset by an increase in automobile loans. Residential mortgage loans decreased $295 million, or two percent, primarily due to a decline in loans held for sale of $241 million from reduced origination volumes. Home equity decreased $121 million, or one percent, from December 31, 2013 as payoffs exceeded new loan production. Credit card loans decreased $117 million, or five percent, from December 31, 2013 due to seasonal trends from the paydown of year-end balances which were higher due to holiday spending. Additionally, automobile loans increased $104 million, or one percent, from December 31, 2013 due to a seasonal increase in originations.

TABLE 12: Components of Average Total Loans and Leases (includes held for sale)

 

     March 31, 2014      March 31, 2013  

For the three months ended ($ in millions)

   Balance      % of Total      Balance      % of Total  

Commercial:

           

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 40,409        46        36,423        41  

Commercial mortgage loans

     7,983        9        8,978        10  

Commercial construction loans

     1,118        1        700        1  

Commercial leases

     3,607        4        3,557        4  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Subtotal – commercial

     53,117        60        49,658        56  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Consumer:

           

Residential mortgage loans

     13,304        15        14,866        17  

Home equity

     9,194        10        9,872        11  

Automobile loans

     12,023        13        12,096        14  

Credit card

     2,230        2        2,069        2  

Other consumer loans and leases

     370        —          319        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Subtotal – consumer

     37,121        40        39,222        44  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total average loans and leases

   $ 90,238        100        88,880        100  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total average portfolio loans and leases (excludes loans held for sale)

   $ 89,530           85,903     
  

 

 

       

 

 

    

Average loans and leases, including loans held for sale, increased $1.4 billion, or two percent, from March 31, 2013. The increase from March 31, 2013 was the result of a $3.5 billion, or seven percent, increase in average commercial loans and leases partially offset by a $2.1 billion, or five percent, decrease in average consumer loans and leases.

 

18


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Average commercial loans and leases increased from March 31, 2013 primarily due to an increase in average commercial and industrial loans and average commercial construction loans partially offset by a decrease in average commercial mortgage loans. Average commercial and industrial loans increased $4.0 billion, or 11%, from March 31, 2013 and average commercial construction loans increased $418 million, or 60%, from March 31, 2013 due to an increase in new loan origination activity from an increase in demand due to a strengthening economy and targeted marketing efforts. Average commercial mortgage loans decreased $995 million, or 11%, from March 31, 2013 due to continued runoff as the level of new originations was less than the repayments on the current portfolio.

Average consumer loans and leases decreased from March 31, 2013 due to a decrease in average residential mortgage loans, average home equity, and average automobile loans, partially offset by an increase in average credit card loans. Average residential mortgage loans decreased $1.6 billion, or 11%, from March 31, 2013 due to a decline in average loans held for sale of $2.1 billion from reduced origination volumes driven by higher mortgage rates partially offset by the continued retention of certain shorter term residential mortgage loans originated through the Bancorp’s retail branches. Average home equity decreased $678 million, or seven percent, from March 31, 2013 as payoffs exceeded new loan production. Average automobile loans decreased $73 million, or one percent, from March 31, 2013 due to a decline in average loans held for sale of $135 million primarily driven by the impact of the securitization and sale of automobile loans in the first quarter of 2013, partially offset by an increase in average portfolio loans of $62 million driven by loan originations exceeding runoff in the following periods. Average credit card loans increased $161 million, or eight percent, from March 31, 2013 due to an increase in open and active accounts driven by the volume of new customer accounts.

Investment Securities

The Bancorp uses investment securities as a means of managing interest rate risk, providing liquidity support and providing collateral for pledging purposes. Total investment securities were $21.3 billion and $19.1 billion at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.

Securities are classified as trading when bought and held principally for the purpose of selling them in the near term. Securities are classified as available-for-sale when, in management’s judgment, they may be sold in response to, or in anticipation of, changes in market conditions. Securities that management has the intent and ability to hold to maturity are classified as held-to-maturity and reported at amortized cost.

At March 31, 2014, the Bancorp’s investment portfolio consisted primarily of AAA-rated available-for-sale securities. The Bancorp did not hold asset-backed securities backed by subprime mortgage loans in its investment portfolio. Additionally, securities classified as below investment grade were immaterial as of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013. The Bancorp’s management has evaluated the securities in an unrealized loss position in the available-for-sale and held-to-maturity portfolios for OTTI. The Bancorp recognized $17 million of OTTI on its available-for sale and other debt securities during the three months ended March 31, 2014 and did not recognize any OTTI on its available-for sale and other debt securities during the three months ended March 31, 2013. The Bancorp did not recognize OTTI on any of its available-for-sale equity securities or its held-to-maturity debt securities during the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013.

TABLE 13: Components of Investment Securities

 

($ in millions)

   March 31,
2014
     December 31,
2013
 

Available-for-sale and other: (amortized cost basis)

     

U.S. Treasury and government agencies

   $ 26        26  

U.S. Government sponsored agencies

     1,522        1,523  

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

     186        187  

Agency mortgage-backed securities(a)

     14,029        12,294  

Other bonds, notes and debentures(b)

     3,917        3,514  

Other securities(c)

     713        865  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total available-for-sale and other securities

   $ 20,393        18,409  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Held-to-maturity: (amortized cost basis)

     

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

   $ 194        207  

Other bonds, notes and debentures

     1        1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total held-to-maturity

   $ 195        208  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trading: (fair value)

     

U.S. Treasury and government agencies

   $ —          1  

U.S. Government sponsored agencies

     5        4  

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

     15        13  

Agency mortgage-backed securities

     3        3  

Other bonds, notes and debentures(b)

     10        7  

Other securities(c)

     314        315  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total trading

   $ 347        343  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Includes interest-only mortgage backed securities of $217 and $262 as of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, recorded at fair value with fair value changes recorded in securities gains, net and securities gains, net non-qualifying hedges on mortgage servicing rights in the Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.
(b) Other bonds, notes, and debentures primarily consist of commercial mortgage-backed securities, certain other asset-backed securities (primarily other consumer loan-backed securities) and corporate bond securities.
(c) Other securities consist of FHLB and FRB restricted stock holdings that are carried at par, FHLMC and FNMA preferred stock holdings and certain mutual fund holdings and equity security holdings.

 

19


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Available-for-sale and other securities on an amortized cost basis increased $2.0 billion, or 11%, from December 31, 2013 primarily due to increases in agency mortgage-backed securities and other bonds, notes, and debentures. Agency mortgage-backed securities increased $1.7 billion, or 14%, from December 31, 2013 due to $3.4 billion in purchases of agency mortgage-backed securities partially offset by $1.3 billion in sales and $386 million in paydowns on the portfolio during the three months ended March 31, 2014. Other bonds, notes, and debentures increased $403 million, or 11%, due to the purchase of $1.3 billion of asset-backed securities partially offset by the sale of $916 million of asset-backed securities, collateralized loan obligations, collateralized mortgage-backed securities and corporate bonds and $10 million of paydowns during the three months ended March 31, 2014.

Available-for-sale securities on an amortized cost basis were 18% and 16% of total interest-earning assets at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. The estimated weighted-average life of the debt securities in the available-for-sale portfolio was 6.7 years at both March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013. In addition, at March 31, 2014, the available-for-sale securities portfolio had a weighted-average yield of 3.49%, compared to 3.39% at December 31, 2013.

Information presented in Table 14 is on a weighted-average life basis, anticipating future prepayments. Yield information is presented on an FTE basis and is computed using historical cost balances. Maturity and yield calculations for the total available-for-sale portfolio exclude equity securities that have no stated yield or maturity. Total net unrealized gains on the available-for-sale securities portfolio were $356 million at March 31, 2014 compared to $188 million at December 31, 2013. The increase from December 31, 2013 was primarily due to a decrease in interest rates during the first quarter of 2014. The fair value of investment securities is impacted by interest rates, credit spreads, market volatility and liquidity conditions. The fair value of investment securities generally increases when interest rates decrease or when credit spreads contract.

TABLE 14: Characteristics of Available-for-Sale and Other Securities

 

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

   Amortized Cost      Fair Value      Weighted-Average
Life (in years)
     Weighted-Average
Yield
 

U.S. Treasury and government agencies:

           

Average life 1 – 5 years

   $ 25        25        2.4        0.81 

Average life 5 – 10 years

     1        1        5.4        1.50  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     26        26        2.5        0.81  

U.S. Government sponsored agencies:

           

Average life 1 – 5 years

     1,522        1,635        2.8        3.64  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,522        1,635        2.8        3.64  

Obligations of states and political subdivisions:(a)

           

Average life 1 – 5 years

     151        156        3.0        2.77  

Average life 5 – 10 years

     24        26        8.3        3.87  

Average life greater than 10 years

     11        12        10.7        3.27  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     186        194        4.1        2.94  

Agency mortgage-backed securities:

           

Average life of one year or less

     90        93        0.6        5.95  

Average life 1 – 5 years

     1,627        1,686        4.0        5.57  

Average life 5 – 10 years

     11,389        11,465        7.0        3.37  

Average life greater than 10 years

     923        941        12.9        3.94  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     14,029        14,185        7.0        3.68  

Other bonds, notes and debentures:

           

Average life of one year or less

     176        181        0.2        1.64  

Average life 1 – 5 years

     1,163        1,197        3.1        2.70  

Average life 5 – 10 years

     2,067        2,085        8.5        3.13  

Average life greater than 10 years

     511        528        14.9        1.97  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     3,917        3,991        7.4        2.78  

Other securities

     713        718        
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total available-for-sale and other securities

   $ 20,393        20,749        6.7        3.49 
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Taxable-equivalent yield adjustments included in the above table are 0.00%, 2.06%, 1.75% and 0.37% for securities with an average life of 1-5 years, 5-10 years, greater than 10 years and in total, respectively.

Deposits

The Bancorp’s deposit balances represent an important source of funding and revenue growth opportunity. The Bancorp continues to focus on core deposit growth in its retail and commercial franchises by improving customer satisfaction, building full relationships and offering competitive rates. Core deposits represented 71% of the Bancorp’s asset funding base at both March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

 

20


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

TABLE 15: Deposits

 

       March 31, 2014        December 31, 2013  
                % of                 % of  

($ in millions)

     Balance        Total        Balance        Total  

Demand

     $ 31,234          32          32,634          32  

Interest checking

       25,472          26          25,875          26  

Savings

       16,867          17          17,045          17  

Money market

       13,208          14          11,644          12  

Foreign office

       1,922          2          1,976          2  
    

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

Transaction deposits

       88,703          91          89,174          89  

Other time

       3,660          4          3,530          4  
    

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

Core deposits

       92,363          95          92,704          93  

Certificates-$100,000 and over

       4,511          5          6,571          7  
    

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total deposits

     $ 96,874          100          99,275          100  
    

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

Core deposits decreased $341 million from December 31, 2013 driven by a decrease of $471 million, or one percent, in transaction deposits partially offset by an increase of $130 million, or four percent, in other time deposits. Total transaction deposits decreased from December 31, 2013 due to a decrease in demand deposits, interest checking deposits and savings deposits partially offset by an increase in money market deposits. Demand deposits decreased $1.4 billion, or four percent, from December 31, 2013 primarily due to uninvested trust funds held in demand deposit accounts at December 31, 2013 that were invested during the first quarter of 2014. The remaining decrease was due to seasonality as commercial customers opted to hold excess cash at December 31, 2013 and reinvest cash during the first quarter of 2014, partially offset by an increase in consumer demand deposits due to seasonality. Interest checking deposits decreased $403 million, or two percent, primarily due to commercial customer seasonality. Money market deposits increased $1.6 billion, or 13%, from December 31, 2013 driven by seasonality and a promotional product offering which drove balance migration from savings deposits which decreased $178 million, or one percent, from December 31, 2013. The increase in other time deposits from December 31, 2013 was primarily the result of the acquisition of new deposits due to competitive interest rates.

The Bancorp uses certificates $100,000 and over as a method to fund earning assets. At March 31, 2014, certificates $100,000 and over decreased $2.1 billion compared to December 31, 2013 primarily due to the maturity of retail and institutional certificates of deposits during the first quarter of 2014.

The following table presents average deposits for the three months ending:

TABLE 16: Average Deposits

 

       March 31, 2014        March 31, 2013  
                % of                 % of  

($ in millions)

     Balance        Total        Balance        Total  

Demand

     $ 30,626          31          28,565          32  

Interest checking

       25,911          27          23,763          27  

Savings

       16,903          17          19,576          22  

Money market

       12,439          13          7,932          9  

Foreign office

       2,017          2          1,102          1  
    

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

Transaction deposits

       87,896          90          80,938          91  

Other time

       3,616          4          3,982          4  
    

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

Core deposits

       91,512          94          84,920          95  

Certificates-$100,000 and over

       5,576          6          4,017          5  

Other

       —            —            40          —    
    

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total average deposits

     $ 97,088          100          88,977          100  
    

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

On an average basis, core deposits increased $6.6 billion, or eight percent, from March 31, 2013 due to an increase of $7.0 billion, or nine percent, in average transaction deposits partially offset by a decrease of $366 million, or nine percent, in average other time deposits. The increase in average transaction deposits was driven by an increase in average money market deposits, average interest checking deposits, average demand deposits and average foreign office deposits partially offset by a decrease in average savings deposits. Average money market deposits increased $4.5 billion, or 57%, from March 31, 2013 primarily due to a promotional product offering which drove balance migration from savings deposits which decreased $2.7 billion, or 14%, from March 31, 2013. The remaining increase in average money market deposits is due to new commercial customer accounts. Average interest checking deposits increased $2.1 billion, or nine percent, from March 31, 2013 primarily due to an increase in average balance per account and new commercial and consumer customer growth. Average demand deposits increased $2.1 billion, or seven percent, from March 31, 2013 due to an increase in average balance per account and new deposit growth. Average foreign office deposits increased $915 million, or 83%, from March 31, 2013 due primarily to new customer accounts and an increase in average balance per account. Average other time deposits decreased $366 million, or nine percent, from March 31, 2013 primarily as a result of continued run-off of certificates of deposits due to the low interest rate environment, as customers have opted to maintain balances in more liquid transaction accounts. Average certificates $100,000 and over increased $1.6 billion, or 39%, from March 31, 2013 due to the diversification of funding sources through the issuance of retail and institutional certificates of deposits during the second half of 2013.

 

21


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Contractual maturities

As of March 31, 2014 the contractual maturities of certificates $100,000 and over are summarized in the following table:

TABLE 17: Contractual Maturities of Certificates—$100,000 and over

 

($ in millions)

      

Three months or less

   $         1,738  

After three months through six months

     1,046  

After six months through 12 months

     656  

After 12 months

     1,071  
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 4,511  
  

 

 

 

As of March 31, 2014 the contractual maturities of other time deposits and certificates $100,000 and over are summarized in the following table:

TABLE 18: Contractual Maturities of Other Time Deposits and Certificates $100,000 and over

 

($ in millions)

      

Next 12 months

   $         5,319  

13-24 months

     1,168  

25-36 months

     736  

37-48 months

     538  

49-60 months

     281  

After 60 months

     129  
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 8,171  
  

 

 

 

Borrowings

Total borrowings increased $2.9 billion, or 26%, from December 31, 2013. Table 19 summarizes the end of period components of total borrowings. As of March 31, 2014, total borrowings as a percentage of interest-bearing liabilities were 18% compared to 14% at December 31, 2013.

TABLE 19: Borrowings

 

($ in millions)

   March 31, 2014      December 31, 2013  

Federal funds purchased

   $ 268        284  

Other short-term borrowings

     2,717        1,380  

Long-term debt

     11,233        9,633  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total borrowings

   $ 14,218        11,297  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Federal funds purchased decreased $16 million, or six percent, from December 31, 2013 driven by a decrease in excess balances in reserve accounts held at Federal Reserve Banks that the Bancorp purchased from other member banks on an overnight basis. Other short-term borrowings increased $1.3 billion, or 97%, from December 31, 2013 driven by an increase of $1.5 billion in short-term FHLB borrowings. The level of these borrowings can fluctuate significantly from period to period depending on funding needs and which sources are used to satisfy those needs. Long-term debt increased by $1.6 billion, or 17%, from December 31, 2013 primarily driven by the issuance of $500 million of unsecured senior bank notes and the issuance of asset-backed securities by a consolidated VIE of $1.3 billion related to an automobile loan securitization in the first quarter of 2014. For additional information regarding long-term debt and the automobile securitization, see Note 8 and Note 12 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

The following table presents average borrowings for the three months ending:

TABLE 20: Average Borrowings

 

($ in millions)

   March 31, 2014      March 31, 2013  

Federal funds purchased

   $ 547        691  

Other short-term borrowings

     1,808        5,429  

Long-term debt

     10,313        7,506  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total average borrowings

   $ 12,668        13,626  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Average total borrowings decreased $958 million, or seven percent, compared to March 31, 2013, primarily due to decreases in average other short-term borrowings and average federal funds purchased partially offset by an increase in average long-term debt. The level of average other short-term borrowings and average federal funds purchased can fluctuate significantly from period to period depending on funding needs and which sources are used to satisfy those needs. The increase in average long-term debt was driven by the aforementioned issuances of long-term debt as discussed above as well as the issuance of $3.1 billion of unsecured senior bank notes, the issuance of $750 million of subordinated notes and the issuance of asset-backed securities by a consolidated VIE of $1.3 billion related to an automobile loan securitization during 2013. The impact of these issuances was partially offset by the maturity of $1.3 billion of senior notes and the redemption of $750 million of outstanding TruPS during 2013. Information on the average rates paid on borrowings is discussed in the net interest income section of the MD&A. In addition, refer to the Liquidity Risk Management section for a discussion on the role of borrowings in the Bancorp’s liquidity management.

 

22


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

BUSINESS SEGMENT REVIEW

The Bancorp reports on four business segments: Commercial Banking, Branch Banking, Consumer Lending and Investment Advisors. Additional detailed financial information on each business segment is included in Note 20 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements. Results of the Bancorp’s business segments are presented based on its management structure and management accounting practices. The structure and accounting practices are specific to the Bancorp; therefore, the financial results of the Bancorp’s business segments are not necessarily comparable with similar information for other financial institutions. The Bancorp refines its methodologies from time to time as management’s accounting practices or businesses change.

The Bancorp manages interest rate risk centrally at the corporate level and employs an FTP methodology at the business segment level. This methodology insulates the business segments from interest rate volatility, enabling them to focus on serving customers through loan and deposit products. The FTP system assigns charge rates and credit rates to classes of assets and liabilities, respectively, based on expected duration and the U.S. swap curve. Matching duration allocates interest income and interest expense to each segment so its resulting net interest income is insulated from interest rate risk. In a rising rate environment, the Bancorp benefits from the widening spread between deposit costs and wholesale funding costs. However, the Bancorp’s FTP system credits this benefit to deposit-providing businesses, such as Branch Banking and Investment Advisors, on a duration-adjusted basis. The net impact of the FTP methodology is captured in General Corporate and Other.

The Bancorp adjusts the FTP charge and credit rates as dictated by changes in interest rates for various interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities and by the review of the estimated durations for the indeterminate-lived deposits. The credit rate provided for demand deposit accounts is reviewed annually based upon the account type, its estimated duration and the corresponding fed funds, U.S. swap curve or swap rate. The credit rates for several deposit products were reset January 1, 2014 to reflect the current market rates and updated duration assumptions. These rates were generally higher than those in place during 2013, thus net interest income for deposit providing businesses was positively impacted for the three months ended March 31, 2014.

The business segments are charged provision expense based on the actual net charge-offs experienced on the loans and leases owned by each segment. Provision expense attributable to loan and lease growth and changes in ALLL factors are captured in General Corporate and Other. The financial results of the business segments include allocations for shared services and headquarters expenses. Even with these allocations, the financial results are not necessarily indicative of the business segments’ financial condition and results of operations as if they existed as independent entities. Additionally, the business segments form synergies by taking advantage of cross-sell opportunities and when funding operations by accessing the capital markets as a collective unit.

The results of operations and financial position for the three months ended March 31, 2013 were restated to reflect the transfer of certain customers and Bancorp employees from Branch Banking to Commercial Banking, effective January 1, 2014. In addition, the prior year balances were restated to reflect a change in internal allocation methodology.

Net income (loss) by business segment is summarized in the following table:

TABLE 21: Business Segment Net Income Available to Common Shareholders

 

     For the three months  
     ended March 31,  

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Income Statement Data

    

Commercial Banking

   $ 164       198  

Branch Banking

     80       34  

Consumer Lending

     (6     70  

Investment Advisors

     17       18  

General Corporate & Other

     64       92  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

     319       412  

Less: Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests

     1       (10
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income attributable to Bancorp

     318       422  

Dividends on preferred stock

     9       9  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income available to common shareholders

   $ 309       413  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

23


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Commercial Banking

Commercial Banking offers credit intermediation, cash management and financial services to large and middle-market businesses and government and professional customers. In addition to the traditional lending and depository offerings, Commercial Banking products and services include global cash management, foreign exchange and international trade finance, derivatives and capital markets services, asset-based lending, real estate finance, public finance, commercial leasing and syndicated finance.

The following table contains selected financial data for the Commercial Banking segment:

TABLE 22: Commercial Banking

 

     For the three months  
     ended March 31,  

($ in millions)

   2014      2013  

Income Statement Data

     

Net interest income (FTE)(a)

   $ 409        389  

Provision for loan and lease losses

     97        44  

Noninterest income:

     

Corporate banking revenue

     104        97  

Service charges on deposits

     69        65  

Other noninterest income

     37        32  

Noninterest expense:

     

Salaries, incentives and benefits

     83        90  

Other noninterest expense

     251        210  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income before taxes

     188        239  

Applicable income tax expense(a)(b)

     24        41  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income

   $ 164        198  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Average Balance Sheet Data

     

Commercial loans, including held for sale

   $ 50,317        46,786  

Demand deposits

     18,158        16,376  

Interest checking

     8,353        7,183  

Savings and money market

     5,900        4,506  

Certificates-$100,000 and over

     1,323        1,273  

Foreign office deposits and other deposits

     2,014        1,090  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Includes FTE adjustments of $5 for both the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013.
(b) Applicable income tax expense for all periods includes the tax benefit from tax-exempt income and business tax credits, partially offset by the effect of certain nondeductible expenses. Refer to the Applicable Income Taxes section of MD&A for additional information.

Net income was $164 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to net income of $198 million for the three months ended March 31, 2013. The decrease in net income was driven by increases in the provision for loan and lease losses and noninterest expense partially offset by increases in net interest income and noninterest income.

Net interest income increased $20 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year. The increase was driven primarily by growth in average commercial and industrial portfolio loans, an increase in the FTP credits due to an increase in average demand deposits and a decrease in the FTP charges on loans due to improvement in the credit quality of commercial portfolio loans and leases, partially offset by a decline in yields of 36 bps on average commercial loans for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013.

Provision for loan and lease losses increased $53 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year due to an increase in net charge-offs related to certain impaired commercial loans. Net charge-offs as a percent of average portfolio loans and leases increased to 79 bps for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to 38 bps for the same period of the prior year.

Noninterest income increased $16 million in the first quarter of 2014 compared to the first quarter of 2013 due to increases in corporate banking revenue, other noninterest income and service charges on deposits. Corporate banking increased $7 million from the prior year quarter primarily driven by increases in syndication fees and lease remarketing. Other noninterest income increased $5 million from the first quarter of 2013 due primarily to an increase in operating lease income. Service charges on deposits increased $4 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in the prior year primarily driven by higher commercial deposit revenue which increased due to the acquisition of new customers.

Noninterest expense increased $34 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year. The increase for the three months ended March 31, 2014 was driven by an increase in other noninterest expense partially offset by a decrease in salaries, incentives and benefits. The increase in other noninterest expense was driven primarily by increases in corporate overhead allocations, impairment on affordable housing investments and operating lease expense. Salaries, incentive and benefits decreased compared to the first quarter of 2013 due primarily to a decrease in incentive compensation resulting from a change to the structure of the incentive compensation plans in the first quarter of 2014.

Average commercial loans increased $3.5 billion for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year primarily due to increases in average commercial and industrial loans and average commercial construction loans partially offset by a decrease in average commercial mortgage loans. Average commercial and industrial portfolio loans and average commercial construction

 

24


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

portfolio loans increased $4.0 billion and $408 million, respectively, for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year due to an increase in new loan origination activity from an increase in demand due to a strengthening economy and targeted marketing efforts. Average commercial mortgage portfolio loans decreased $962 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year due to continued run-off as the level of new originations was below the level of repayments on the current portfolio.

Average core deposits increased $5.3 billion for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013. The increase was primarily driven by increases in average demand deposits, average savings and money market deposits, average interest checking balances and foreign deposits, which increased $1.8 billion, $1.4 billion, $1.2 billion and $923 million, respectively, for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year.

Branch Banking

Branch Banking provides a full range of deposit and loan and lease products to individuals and small businesses through 1,311 full-service Banking Centers. Branch Banking offers depository and loan products, such as checking and savings accounts, home equity loans and lines of credit, credit cards and loans for automobiles and other personal financing needs, as well as products designed to meet the specific needs of small businesses, including cash management services.

The following table contains selected financial data for the Branch Banking segment:

TABLE 23: Branch Banking

 

     For the three months  
     ended March 31,  

($ in millions)

   2014      2013  

Income Statement Data

     

Net interest income

   $ 385        323  

Provision for loan and lease losses

     45        57  

Noninterest income:

     

Service charges on deposits

     63        65  

Card and processing revenue

     51        49  

Investment advisory revenue

     36        37  

Other noninterest income

     22        27  

Noninterest expense:

     

Salaries, incentives and benefits

     140        145  

Net occupancy and equipment expense

     61        60  

Card and processing expense

     29        29  

Other noninterest expense

     160        156  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income before taxes

     122        54  

Applicable income tax expense

     42        20  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income

   $ 80        34  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Average Balance Sheet Data

     

Consumer loans, including held for sale

   $ 15,102        15,124  

Commercial loans, including held for sale

     1,700        1,844  

Demand deposits

     10,996        10,034  

Interest checking

     9,205        8,967  

Savings and money market

     22,611        22,165  

Other time and certificates-$100,000 and over

     4,491        4,971  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income was $80 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to net income of $34 million for the three months ended March 31, 2013. The increase was driven by an increase in net interest income and a decline in the provision for loan and lease losses, partially offset by a decrease in noninterest income.

Net interest income increased $62 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year. The primary drivers of the increase are increases in the FTP credit rates for savings and money market deposits and interest checking deposits and a decline in interest expense on core deposits due to favorable shifts from certificates of deposit to lower cost transaction deposits.

Provision for loan and lease losses for the three months ended March 31, 2014 decreased $12 million compared to the first quarter of 2013. Net charge-offs as a percent of average loans and leases decreased to 108 bps for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to 136 bps for the same period of the prior year as a result of improved credit trends.

Noninterest income decreased $6 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year. The decrease was primarily driven by a $5 million decrease in other noninterest income compared to the first quarter in 2013 due primarily to a decline in mortgage origination fees and gains on loan sales and lower retail service fees.

Noninterest expense was flat from the three months ended March 31, 2013, primarily driven by a $5 million decrease in salaries, incentives and benefits offset by increases in other noninterest expense and net occupancy and equipment expense, which increased $4 million and $1 million, respectively. The decrease in salaries, incentives and benefits was primarily driven by lower compensation and bonus and incentives.

 

25


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

The increase in other noninterest expense for the three months ended March 31, 2014 was primarily driven by higher corporate overhead allocations partially offset by decreases in loan and lease expense and marketing expense.

Average consumer loans decreased $22 million for the first quarter of 2014 compared to the same period in the prior year primarily due to a decrease in average home equity loans of $620 million, as payoffs exceeded new loan production, and a decrease in average automobile loans of $48 million. The decrease in average home equity and automobile loans was partially offset by increases in average residential mortgage loans and average credit card loans of $490 million and $156 million, respectively. The increase in average residential mortgage portfolio loans was due to the continued retention of certain shorter term residential mortgage loans. Average credit card loans increased due to higher average balances per account and the acquisition of new customers.

Average core deposits increased by $1.3 billion for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in the prior year as the growth in transaction accounts due to excess customer liquidity and historically low interest rates outpaced the run-off of higher priced other time deposits.

Consumer Lending

Consumer Lending includes the Bancorp’s mortgage, home equity, automobile and other indirect lending activities. Mortgage and home equity lending activities include the origination, retention and servicing of mortgage, automobile and home equity loans or lines of credit, sales and securitizations of those loans, pools of loans or lines of credit, and all associated hedging activities. Indirect lending activities include extending loans to consumers through mortgage brokers and automobile dealers.

The following table contains selected financial data for the Consumer Lending segment:

TABLE 24: Consumer Lending

 

     For the three months  
     ended March 31,  

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Income Statement Data

    

Net interest income

   $ 64       85  

Provision for loan and lease losses

     25       29  

Noninterest income:

    

Mortgage banking net revenue

     108       216  

Other noninterest income

     10       13  

Noninterest expense:

    

Salaries, incentives and benefits

     34       63  

Other noninterest expense

     132       114  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

(Loss) income before taxes

     (9     108  

Applicable income tax (benefit) expense

     (3     38  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (loss) income

   $ (6     70  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Average Balance Sheet Data

    

Residential mortgage loans, including held for sale

   $ 8,819       11,053  

Home equity

     510       595  

Automobile loans, including held for sale

     11,452       11,467  

Other consumer loans and leases

     26       9  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Consumer Lending incurred a net loss of $6 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to net income of $70 million for the same period in the prior year. The net loss for the first quarter of 2014 was driven by decreases in noninterest income and net interest income partially offset by declines in noninterest expense and the provision for loan and lease losses.

Net interest income decreased $21 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013. The decrease was primarily driven by decreases in average residential mortgage loans and average home equity loans and lower yields on average residential mortgage loans and average automobile loans partially offset by a decrease in FTP charges on loans.

Provision for loan and lease losses decreased $4 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year, as delinquency metrics and underlying loss trends improved primarily in residential mortgage loans and home equity loans. Net charge-offs as a percent of average loans and leases decreased to 51 bps for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to 58 bps for the same period of the prior year.

Noninterest income decreased $111 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year primarily due to a decrease in mortgage banking net revenue of $108 million. The decrease was driven by a decrease in mortgage origination fees and gains on loan sales of $125 million partially offset by a $17 million increase in residential mortgage servicing revenue. Refer to the Noninterest Income section of MD&A for additional information on the fluctuations in mortgage banking net revenue.

Noninterest expense decreased $11 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year driven primarily by a decline of $29 million in salaries, incentives and benefits which decreased primarily as a result of lower mortgage loan originations. The decrease in salaries, incentive and benefits was partially offset by an increase of $18 million in other noninterest expense. Other noninterest expense increased due primarily to higher litigation expense partially offset by decreases in representation and warranty expense, loan and lease expense and corporate overhead allocations.

 

26


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Average consumer loans and leases decreased $2.3 billion for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year. Average residential mortgage loans decreased $2.2 billion compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013 due primarily to a decline of $2.1 billion in average residential mortgage loans held for sale from reduced origination volumes driven by higher mortgage rates partially offset by the continued retention of certain shorter term residential mortgage loans.

Investment Advisors

Investment Advisors provides a full range of investment alternatives for individuals, companies and not-for-profit organizations. Investment Advisors is made up of four main businesses: FTS, an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of the Bancorp; ClearArc Capital, Inc. (formerly Fifth Third Asset Management, Inc.), an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of the Bancorp; Fifth Third Private Bank; and Fifth Third Institutional Services. FTS offers full service retail brokerage services to individual clients and broker dealer services to the institutional marketplace. ClearArc Capital, Inc. provides asset management services. Fifth Third Private Bank offers holistic strategies to affluent clients in wealth planning, investing, insurance and wealth protection. Fifth Third Institutional Services provides advisory services for institutional clients including states and municipalities.

The following table contains selected financial data for the Investment Advisors segment:

TABLE 25: Investment Advisors

 

     For the three months  
     ended March 31,  

($ in millions)

   2014      2013  

Income Statement Data

     

Net interest income

   $ 32        36  

Provision for loan and lease losses

     —          1  

Noninterest income:

     

Investment advisory revenue

     100        98  

Other noninterest income

     3        10  

Noninterest expense:

     

Salaries, incentives and benefits

     43        42  

Other noninterest expense

     67        73  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income before taxes

     25        28  

Applicable income tax expense

     8        10  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income

   $ 17        18  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Average Balance Sheet Data

     

Loans and leases

   $ 2,209        1,925  

Core deposits

     9,557        8,746  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income was $17 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to net income of $18 million for the same period in the prior year. The decrease in net income included decreases in noninterest income and net interest income partially offset by decreases in noninterest expense and the provision for loan and lease losses. Net interest income decreased $4 million due to a decrease in FTP credits on interest checking deposits. Provision for loan and leases losses decreased $1 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared with the same period in the prior year as a result of improved credit trends. Net charge-offs as a percent of average loans and leases decreased to 7 bps for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to 14 bps for the same period of the prior year.

Noninterest income decreased $5 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014, primarily driven by a $7 million decrease in other noninterest income partially offset by a $2 million increase in investment advisory revenue. The prior year period included a $7 million gain on the sale of certain advisory contracts which were sold in the first quarter of 2013. The increase in investment advisory revenue was due primarily to an increase in private client services revenue.

Noninterest expense decreased $5 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year, primarily driven by a decrease in other noninterest expense of $6 million due primarily to a decrease in corporate overhead allocations, partially offset by an increase in salaries, incentives and benefits of $1 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014.

Average loans and leases increased $284 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 primarily due to increases in residential mortgage, commercial mortgage, other consumer, and home equity loans. Average core deposits increased $811 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period of the prior year, primarily due to growth in interest checking as customers have opted to maintain excess funds in liquid transaction accounts as a result of interest rates remaining near historic lows.

General Corporate and Other

General Corporate and Other includes the unallocated portion of the investment securities portfolio, securities gains and losses, certain non-core deposit funding, unassigned equity, provision expense in excess of net charge-offs or a benefit from the reduction of the ALLL, representation and warranty expense in excess of actual losses or a benefit from the reduction of representation and warranty reserves, the payment of preferred stock dividends and certain support activities and other items not attributed to the business segments.

 

27


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Results for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013 were impacted by a benefit of $98 million and $69 million, respectively, due to reductions in the ALLL. Net interest income for the three months ended March 31, 2014 was $8 million compared to $60 million in the same period in 2013 primarily due to a decrease in the benefit related to the FTP charges on loans, partially offset by an increase in interest income on taxable securities and decreases in interest expense on long-term debt and other short-term borrowings. Noninterest income for the first quarter of 2014 included a $36 million negative valuation adjustment on the Vantiv warrant and a $1 million positive valuation adjustment related to the valuation of the Visa total return swap compared with a $34 million positive valuation adjustment on the Vantiv warrant and a $7 million negative valuation adjustment on the Visa total return swap for the first quarter of 2013.

Noninterest expense for the three months ended March 31, 2014 was a benefit of $15 million compared to an expense of $32 million for the three months ended March 31, 2013 primarily due to an increase in the benefit from other noninterest expense driven by increased corporate overhead allocations from Generate Corporate and Other to the other business segments.

 

28


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

RISK MANAGEMENT – OVERVIEW

Managing risk is an essential component of successfully operating a financial services company. The Bancorp’s risk management approach includes processes for identifying, assessing, managing, monitoring and reporting risks. The ERM division and the Bancorp Credit division, led by the Bancorp’s Chief Risk and Credit Officer, ensure the consistency and adequacy of the Bancorp’s risk management approach within the structure of the Bancorp’s affiliate operating model. In addition, the Internal Audit division provides an independent assessment of the Bancorp’s internal control structure and related systems and processes.

The assumption of risk requires robust and active risk management practices that comprise an integrated and comprehensive set of activities, measures and strategies that apply to the entire organization. The Bancorp has established a Risk Appetite Framework, approved by the Board, that provides the foundations of corporate risk capacity, risk appetite and risk tolerances. The Bancorp’s risk capacity is represented by its available financial resources. Risk capacity sets an absolute limit on risk-assumption in the Bancorp’s annual and strategic plans. The Bancorp understands that not all financial resources may persist as viable loss buffers over time. Further, consideration must be given to planned or foreseeable events that would reduce risk capacity. Those factors take the form of capacity adjustments to arrive at an Operating Risk Capacity which represents the operating risk level the Bancorp can assume while maintaining its solvency standard. The Bancorp’s policy currently discounts its Operating Risk Capacity by a minimum of five percent to provide a buffer; as a result, the Bancorp’s risk appetite is limited by policy to, at most, 95% of its Operating Risk Capacity.

Economic capital is the amount of unencumbered financial resources required to support the Bancorp’s risks. The Bancorp measures economic capital under the assumption that it expects to maintain debt ratings at strong investment grade levels over time. The Bancorp’s capital policies require that the Operating Risk Capacity less the aforementioned buffer exceed the calculated economic capital required in its business.

Risk appetite is the aggregate amount of risk the Bancorp is willing to accept in pursuit of its strategic and financial objectives. By establishing boundaries around risk taking and business decisions, and by incorporating the needs and goals of its shareholders, regulators, rating agencies and customers, the Bancorp’s risk appetite is aligned with its priorities and goals. Risk tolerance is the maximum amount of risk applicable to each of the eight specific risk categories included in its Enterprise Risk Management Framework. This is expressed primarily in qualitative terms. The Bancorp’s risk appetite and risk tolerances are supported by risk targets and risk limits. Those limits are used to monitor the amount of risk assumed at a granular level. On a quarterly basis, the Risk and Compliance Committee of the Board reviews performance against key risk limits as well as current assessments of each of the eight risk types relative to the established tolerance. Any results over limits or outside of tolerance require the development of an action plan that describes actions to be taken to return the measure to within the limit or tolerance.

The risks faced by the Bancorp include, but are not limited to, credit, market, liquidity, operational, regulatory compliance, legal, reputational and strategic. Each of these risks is managed through the Bancorp’s risk program which includes the following key functions:

 

   

Enterprise Risk Management Programs is responsible for developing and overseeing the implementation of risk programs and reporting that facilitate a broad integrated view of risk. The department also leads the continual fostering of a strong risk management culture and the framework, policies and committees that support effective risk governance, including the oversight of Sarbanes-Oxley compliance;

 

   

Commercial Credit Risk Management provides safety and soundness within an independent portfolio management framework that supports the Bancorp’s commercial loan growth strategies and underwriting practices, ensuring portfolio optimization and appropriate risk controls;

 

   

Risk Strategies and Reporting is responsible for quantitative analysis needed to support the commercial dual rating methodology, ALLL methodology and analytics needed to assess credit risk and develop mitigation strategies related to that risk. The department also provides oversight, reporting and monitoring of commercial underwriting and credit administration processes. The Risk Strategies and Reporting department is also responsible for the economic capital program;

 

   

Consumer Credit Risk Management provides safety and soundness within an independent management framework that supports the Bancorp’s consumer loan growth strategies, ensuring portfolio optimization, appropriate risk controls and oversight, reporting, and monitoring of underwriting and credit administration processes;

 

   

Operational Risk Management works with affiliates and lines of business to maintain processes to monitor and manage all aspects of operational risk, including ensuring consistency in application of operational risk programs;

 

   

Bank Protection oversees and manages fraud prevention and detection and provides investigative and recovery services for the Bancorp;

 

   

Capital Markets Risk Management is responsible for instituting, monitoring, and reporting appropriate trading limits, monitoring liquidity, interest rate risk and risk tolerances within Treasury, Mortgage, and Capital Markets groups and utilizing a value at risk model for Bancorp market risk exposure;

 

   

Regulatory Compliance Risk Management ensures that processes are in place to monitor and comply with federal and state banking regulations, including processes related to fiduciary, community reinvestment act and fair lending compliance. The function also has the responsibility for maintenance of an enterprise-wide compliance framework; and

 

   

The ERM division creates and maintains other functions, committees or processes as are necessary to effectively manage risk throughout the Bancorp.

 

29


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Risk management oversight and governance is provided by the Risk and Compliance Committee of the Board of Directors and through multiple management committees whose membership includes a broad cross-section of line-of-business, affiliate and support representatives. The Risk and Compliance Committee of the Board of Directors consists of five outside directors and has the responsibility for the oversight of risk management for the Bancorp, as well as for the Bancorp’s overall aggregate risk profile. The Risk and Compliance Committee of the Board of Directors has approved the formation of key management governance committees that are responsible for evaluating risks and controls. The primary committee responsible for the oversight of risk management is the ERMC. Committees accountable to the ERMC, which support the core risk programs, are the Corporate Credit Committee, the Operational Risk Committee, the Management Compliance Committee, the Asset/Liability Committee and the Enterprise Marketing Committee. Other committees accountable to the ERMC oversee the ALLL, capital and community reinvestment act/fair lending functions. There are also new products and initiatives processes applicable to every line of business to ensure an appropriate standard readiness assessment is performed before launching a new product or initiative. Significant risk policies approved by the management governance committees are also reviewed and approved by the Risk and Compliance Committee of the Board of Directors.

Credit Risk Review is an independent function responsible for evaluating the sufficiency of underwriting, documentation and approval processes for consumer and commercial credits, the accuracy of risk grades assigned to commercial credit exposure, nonaccrual status, specific reserves and monitoring for charge-offs. Credit Risk Review reports directly to the Risk and Compliance Committee of the Board of Directors and administratively to the Chief Auditor.

There have been significant changes within the mortgage industry over the past several years; as such the Bancorp conducts regular reviews of the industries we serve based on the changing competitive and regulatory environment. Based on our recent review, the Bancorp exited the Residential Wholesale Loan Broker business during the first quarter of 2014.

CREDIT RISK MANAGEMENT

The objective of the Bancorp’s credit risk management strategy is to quantify and manage credit risk on an aggregate portfolio basis, as well as to limit the risk of loss resulting from the failure of a borrower or counterparty to honor its financial or contractual obligations to the Bancorp. The Bancorp’s credit risk management strategy is based on three core principles: conservatism, diversification and monitoring. The Bancorp believes that effective credit risk management begins with conservative lending practices. These practices include conservative exposure and counterparty limits and conservative underwriting, documentation and collection standards. The Bancorp’s credit risk management strategy also emphasizes diversification on a geographic, industry and customer level as well as ongoing portfolio monitoring and timely management reviews of large credit exposures and credits experiencing deterioration of credit quality. Credit officers with the authority to extend credit are delegated specific authority amounts, the utilization of which is closely monitored. Underwriting activities are centrally managed, and ERM manages the policy and the authority delegation process directly. The Credit Risk Review function provides objective assessments of the quality of underwriting and documentation, the accuracy of risk grades and the charge-off, nonaccrual and reserve analysis process. The Bancorp’s credit review process and overall assessment of the adequacy of the allowance for credit losses is based on quarterly assessments of the probable estimated losses inherent in the loan and lease portfolio. The Bancorp uses these assessments to promptly identify potential problem loans or leases within the portfolio, maintain an adequate reserve and take any necessary charge-offs. The Bancorp defines potential problem loans as those rated substandard that do not meet the definition of a nonperforming asset or a restructured loan. See Note 6 of the Notes to the Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements for further information on the Bancorp’s credit grade categories, which are derived from standard regulatory rating definitions.

The following tables provide a summary of potential problem loans:

TABLE 26: Potential Problem Loans

 

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

   Carrying
Value
     Unpaid
Principal
Balance
     Exposure  

Commercial and industrial

   $ 960        962        1,294  

Commercial mortgage

     429        430        429  

Commercial construction

     34        34        37  

Commercial leases

     26        26        26  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,449        1,452        1,786  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

TABLE 27: Potential Problem Loans

 

As of December 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

   Carrying
Value
     Unpaid
Principal
Balance
     Exposure  

Commercial and industrial

   $ 1,032        1,034        1,323  

Commercial mortgage

     517        520        520  

Commercial construction

     44        44        50  

Commercial leases

     18        18        18  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,611        1,616        1,911  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

In addition to the individual review of larger commercial loans that exhibit probable or observed credit weaknesses, the commercial credit review process includes the use of two risk grading systems. The risk grading system currently utilized for reserve analysis purposes encompasses ten categories. The Bancorp also maintains a dual risk rating system for credit approval and pricing, portfolio monitoring and

 

30


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

capital allocation that includes a “through-the-cycle” rating philosophy for modeling expected losses. The dual risk rating system includes thirteen probabilities of default grade categories and an additional six grade categories for estimating losses given an event of default. The probability of default and loss given default evaluations are not separated in the ten-category risk rating system. The Bancorp has completed significant validation and testing of the dual risk rating system as a commercial credit risk management tool. The Bancorp is assessing the necessary modifications to the dual risk rating system outputs to develop a U.S. GAAP compliant ALLL model and will make a decision on the use of modified dual risk ratings for purposes of determining the Bancorp’s ALLL once the FASB has issued a final standard regarding proposed methodology changes to the determination of credit impairment as outlined in the FASB’s Proposed Accounting Standard Update-Financial Instruments-Credit Losses (Subtopic 825-15) issued on December 20, 2012. Scoring systems, various analytical tools and portfolio performance monitoring are used to assess the credit risk in the Bancorp’s homogenous consumer and small business loan portfolios.

Overview

Economic growth in the first quarter of 2014 was sluggish, due in part to severe weather conditions. However, GDP is expected to rise as the year progresses. The job market is slowly but steadily improving and the economy continues to trend modestly upward. Economic risks include how the Federal Reserve handles the end of quantitative easing and an increase in interest rates. Housing prices have largely stabilized and are increasing in many markets, but overall current economic conditions are causing weaker than desired qualified loan demand and a relatively low interest rate environment, which directly impacts the Bancorp’s growth and profitability.

Among consumer portfolios, residential mortgage and brokered home equity portfolios exhibited the most stress. Management suspended homebuilder and developer lending in 2007 and new commercial non-owner occupied real estate lending in 2008, discontinued the origination of brokered home equity products at the end of 2007 and tightened underwriting standards across both the commercial and consumer loan product offerings. As of March 31, 2014, consumer real estate loans originated from 2005 through 2008 represent approximately 29% of the consumer real estate portfolio and approximately 56% of total losses in 2014. Loss rates continue to improve as newer vintages are performing within expectations. With the stabilization of certain real estate markets, the Bancorp began to selectively originate new homebuilder and developer lending and non-owner occupied commercial lending real estate in the third quarter of 2011. However, the level of new fundings is below the amortization and pay-off of the current portfolio. The Bancorp continues to aggressively engage in other loss mitigation strategies such as reducing credit commitments, restructuring certain commercial and consumer loans, as well as utilizing commercial and consumer loan workout teams. For commercial and consumer loans owned by the Bancorp, loan modification strategies are developed that are workable for both the borrower and the Bancorp when the borrower displays a willingness to cooperate. These strategies typically involve either a reduction of the stated interest rate of the loan, an extension of the loan’s maturity date(s) with a stated rate lower than the current market rate for a new loan with similar risk, or in limited circumstances, a reduction of the principal balance of the loan or the loan’s accrued interest. For residential mortgage loans serviced for FHLMC and FNMA, the Bancorp participates in the HAMP and HARP 2.0 programs. For loans refinanced under the HARP 2.0 program, the Bancorp strictly adheres to the underwriting requirements of the program and promptly sells the refinanced loan back to the agencies. Loan restructuring under the HAMP program is performed on behalf of FHLMC or FNMA and the Bancorp does not take possession of these loans during the modification process. Therefore, participation in these programs does not significantly impact the Bancorp’s credit quality statistics. The Bancorp participates in trial modifications in conjunction with the HAMP program for loans it services for FHLMC and FNMA. As these trial modifications relate to loans serviced for others, they are not included in the Bancorp’s troubled debt restructurings as they are not assets of the Bancorp. In the event there is a representation and warranty violation on loans sold through the programs, the Bancorp may be required to repurchase the sold loan. As of March 31, 2014, repurchased loans restructured or refinanced under these programs were immaterial to the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements. Additionally, as of March 31, 2014, $54 million of loans refinanced under HARP 2.0 were included in loans held for sale in the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. For the three months ended March 31, 2014, the Bancorp recognized $5 million of noninterest income in mortgage banking net revenue in the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income related to the sale of loans restructured or refinanced under the HAMP and HARP 2.0 programs.

In the financial services industry, there has been heightened focus on foreclosure activity and processes. The Bancorp actively works with borrowers experiencing difficulties and has regularly modified or provided forbearance to borrowers where a workable solution could be found. Foreclosure is a last resort, and the Bancorp undertakes foreclosures only when it believes they are necessary and appropriate and is careful to ensure that customer and loan data are accurate.

During the fourth quarter of 2013, the Bancorp settled certain repurchase claims related to mortgage loans originated and sold to FHLMC prior to January 1, 2009 for $25 million, after paid claim credits and other adjustments. The settlement removes the Bancorp’s responsibility to repurchase or indemnify FHLMC for representation and warranty violations on any loan sold prior to January 1, 2009 except in limited circumstances.

Commercial Portfolio

The Bancorp’s credit risk management strategy includes minimizing concentrations of risk through diversification. The Bancorp has commercial loan concentration limits based on industry, lines of business within the commercial segment, geography and credit product type.

The risk within the commercial loan and lease portfolio is managed and monitored through an underwriting process utilizing detailed origination policies, continuous loan level reviews, monitoring of industry concentration and product type limits and continuous portfolio risk management reporting. The origination policies for commercial real estate outline the risks and underwriting requirements for owner and non-owner occupied and construction lending. Included in the policies are maturity and amortization terms, maximum LTVs, minimum debt service coverage ratios, construction loan monitoring procedures, appraisal requirements, pre-leasing requirements (as applicable) and sensitivity and pro-forma analysis requirements. The Bancorp requires a valuation of real estate collateral, which may include third-party appraisals, be performed at the time of origination and renewal in accordance with regulatory requirements and on an as needed basis when market conditions justify. Although the Bancorp does not back test these collateral value assumptions, the Bancorp maintains an appraisal review department to order and review third-party appraisals in accordance with regulatory requirements. Collateral values on criticized

 

31


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

assets with relationships exceeding $1 million are reviewed quarterly to assess the appropriateness of the value ascribed in the assessment of charge-offs and specific reserves. In addition, the Bancorp applies incremental valuation haircuts to older appraisals that relate to collateral dependent loans, which can currently be up to 20-30% of the appraised value based on the type of collateral. These incremental valuation haircuts generally reflect the age of the most recent appraisal as well as collateral type. Trends in collateral values, such as home price indices and recent asset dispositions, are monitored in order to determine whether adjustments to the appraisal haircuts are warranted. Other factors such as local market conditions or location may also be considered as necessary.

The Bancorp assesses all real estate and non-real estate collateral securing a loan and considers all cross collateralized loans in the calculation of the LTV ratio. The following table provides detail on the most recent LTV ratios for commercial mortgage loans greater than $1 million, excluding impaired commercial mortgage loans individually evaluated. The Bancorp does not typically aggregate the LTV ratios for commercial mortgage loans less than $1 million.

TABLE 28: Commercial Mortgage Loans Outstanding by LTV, Loans Greater Than $1 Million

 

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

   LTV > 100%      LTV 80-100%      LTV < 80%  

Commercial mortgage owner occupied loans

   $ 223        303        2,152  

Commercial mortgage non-owner occupied loans

     225        352        1,873  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 448        655        4,025  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

TABLE 29: Commercial Mortgage Loans Outstanding by LTV, Loans Greater Than $1 Million

 

As of December 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

   LTV > 100%      LTV 80-100%      LTV < 80%  

Commercial mortgage owner occupied loans

   $ 240        345        2,152  

Commercial mortgage non-owner occupied loans

     274        353        1,798  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 514        698        3,950  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

32


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

The following table provides detail on commercial loans and leases by industry classification (as defined by the North American Industry Classification System), by loan size and by state, illustrating the diversity and granularity of the Bancorp’s commercial loans and leases:

TABLE 30: Commercial Loan and Lease Portfolio (excluding loans held for sale)

 

     March 31, 2014      December 31, 2013  

(S in millions)

   Outstanding     Exposure      Nonaccrual      Outstanding     Exposure      Nonaccrual  

By industry:

               

Manufacturing

   $ 10,746       20,091        81      $ 10,299       19,955        55  

Financial services and insurance

     6,247       14,194        21        5,998       14,010        25  

Real estate

     5,124       7,665        70        5,027       7,302        70  

Business services

     4,855       7,335        73        4,910       7,411        55  

Wholesale trade

     4,443       8,188        23        4,407       8,406        35  

Healthcare

     4,139       6,240        27        4,038       6,220        26  

Retail trade

     3,367       6,727        26        3,301       6,673        18  

Transportation and warehousing

     3,098       4,416        1        3,134       4,416        1  

Communication and information

     2,086       3,782        2        1,801       3,295        2  

Construction

     1,973       3,300        37        1,865       3,196        36  

Accommodation and food

     1,668       2,691        10        1,668       2,556        12  

Mining

     1,637       3,123        38        1,580       3,206        55  

Entertainment and recreation

     1,134       1,995        12        1,149       1,955        12  

Other services

     982       1,314        13        1,013       1,362        24  

Utilities

     777       2,352        —          773       2,332        —    

Public administration

     527       729        —          541       734        —    

Agribusiness

     351       493        25        356       504        26  

Individuals

     180       225        5        174       218        6  

Other

     10       15        —          12       12        —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 53,344       94,875        464      $ 52,046       93,763        458  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

By loan size:

               

Less than $200,000

         1        7            1        8  

$200,000 to $1 million

     5       4        18        5       4        18  

$1 million to $5 million

     12       10        23        13       10        23  

$5 million to $10 million

     9       8        13        10       8        10  

$10 million to $25 million

     27       23        32        27       23        34  

Greater than $25 million

     46       54        7        44       54        7  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     100      100        100        100      100        100  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

By state:

               

Ohio

     18      21        14        19      22        16  

Michigan

     10       8        12        10       8        11  

Illinois

     7       8        7        7       7        8  

Florida

     7       6        16        7       6        19  

Indiana

     5       5        8        5       5        9  

Kentucky

     3       3        2        3       3        2  

North Carolina

     3       3        1        3       3        1  

Tennessee

     3       3        1        3       3        1  

Pennsylvania

     3       2        6        3       3        7  

All other states

     41       41        33        40       40        26  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     100      100        100        100      100        100  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Bancorp has identified certain categories of loans which it believes represent a higher level of risk compared to the rest of the Bancorp’s loan portfolio, due to economic or market conditions within the Bancorp’s key lending areas. The following tables provide analysis of each of the categories of loans (excluding loans held for sale) by state as of and for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013:

TABLE 31: Non-Owner Occupied Commercial Real Estate(a)

 

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

            For the three months ended
March 31, 2014
 

By State:

   Outstanding      Exposure      90 Days
Past Due
     Nonaccrual      Net Charge-
offs
 

Ohio

   $ 1,081        1,457        —          14        1  

Michigan

     814        906        —          24        —    

Florida

     516        649        —          6        —    

Illinois

     438        731        —          6        —    

North Carolina

     284        459        —          3        —    

Indiana

     168        266        —          3        —    

All other states

     1,362        2,372        —          5        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 4,663        6,840        —          61        1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Included in commercial mortgage and commercial construction loans on the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets.

 

33


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

TABLE 32: Non-Owner Occupied Commercial Real Estate(a)

 

As of March 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

            For the three months
ended March 31, 2013
 

By State:

   Outstanding      Exposure      90 Days
Past Due
     Nonaccrual      Net Charge-
offs
 

Ohio

   $ 1,144        1,308        —          25        12  

Michigan

     1,018        1,082        —          48        —    

Florida

     539        592        —          32        4  

Illinois

     417        487        —          15        —    

Indiana

     238        255        —          10        —    

North Carolina

     192        248        —          7        —    

All other states

     1,020        1,326        —          29        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 4,568        5,298        —          166        16  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Included in commercial mortgage and commercial construction loans on the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets.

 

34


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Consumer Portfolio

The Bancorp’s consumer portfolio is materially comprised of three categories of loans: residential mortgage, home equity, and automobile. The Bancorp has identified certain categories within these loan types which it believes represent a higher level of risk compared to the rest of the consumer loan portfolio due to high loan amount to collateral value. The Bancorp does not update LTV ratios for the consumer portfolio subsequent to origination except as part of the charge-off process for real estate secured loans.

Residential Mortgage Portfolio

The Bancorp manages credit risk in the residential mortgage portfolio through conservative underwriting and documentation standards and geographic and product diversification. The Bancorp may also package and sell loans in the portfolio.

The Bancorp does not originate mortgage loans that permit customers to defer principal payments or make payments that are less than the accruing interest. The Bancorp originates both fixed and adjustable rate residential mortgage loans. Resets of rates on adjustable rate mortgages are not expected to have a material impact on credit costs in the current interest rate environment, as approximately $950 million of adjustable rate residential mortgage loans will have rate resets during the next twelve months, with less than one percent of those resets expected to experience an increase in monthly payments in comparison to the monthly payment at the time of origination.

Certain residential mortgage products have contractual features that may increase credit exposure to the Bancorp in the event of a decline in housing values. These types of mortgage products offered by the Bancorp include loans with high LTV ratios, multiple loans on the same collateral that when combined result in an LTV greater than 80% and interest-only loans. The Bancorp has deemed residential mortgage loans with greater than 80% LTV ratios and no mortgage insurance as loans that represent a higher level of risk.

The following table provides an analysis of the residential mortgage portfolio loans outstanding by LTV at origination:

TABLE 33: Residential Mortgage Portfolio Loans by LTV at Origination

 

     March 31, 2014     December 31, 2013  

($ in millions)

   Outstanding      Weighted
Average
LTV
    Outstanding      Weighted
Average
LTV
 

LTV £ 80%

   $ 9,429        65.3    $ 9,507        65.2 

LTV > 80%, with mortgage insurance

     1,253        93.7       1,242        93.7  

LTV > 80%, no mortgage insurance

     1,944        95.9       1,931        95.9  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 12,626        72.9    $ 12,680        72.7 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following tables provide analysis of the residential mortgage portfolio loans outstanding with a greater than 80% LTV ratio and no mortgage insurance:

TABLE 34: Residential Mortgage Portfolio Loans, LTV Greater Than 80%, No Mortgage Insurance

 

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

                        For the
three  months
ended
March 31, 2014
 

By State:

   Outstanding      90 Days
Past Due
     Nonaccrual      Net Charge-offs  

Ohio

   $ 577        2        18        2  

Michigan

     307        1        7        1  

Florida

     258        1        8        1  

Illinois

     243        1        5        1  

Indiana

     122        1        4        —    

North Carolina

     95        —          2        —    

Kentucky

     82        —          2        —    

All other states

     260        1        2        1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,944        7        48        6  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

35


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

TABLE 35: Residential Mortgage Portfolio Loans, LTV Greater Than 80%, No Mortgage Insurance

 

As of March 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

                        For the
three months
ended
March 31, 2013
 

By State:

   Outstanding      90 Days
Past Due
     Nonaccrual      Net Charge-offs  

Ohio

   $ 588        2        23        3  

Michigan

     305        1        9        2  

Florida

     259        1        17        1  

Illinois

     197        1        4        1  

Indiana

     116        1        5        —    

North Carolina

     104        —          3        —    

Kentucky

     87        2        3        —    

All other states

     183        1        3        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,839        9        67        7  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Home Equity Portfolio

The Bancorp’s home equity portfolio is primarily comprised of home equity lines of credit. Beginning in the first quarter of 2013, the Bancorp’s newly originated home equity lines of credit have a 10-year interest only draw period followed by a 20-year amortization period. The home equity line of credit previously offered by the Bancorp was a revolving facility with a 20-year term, minimum payments of interest only and a balloon payment of principal at maturity.

The ALLL provides coverage for probable and estimable losses in the home equity portfolio. The allowance attributable to the portion of the home equity portfolio that has not been restructured in a TDR is calculated on a pooled basis with senior lien and junior-lien categories segmented in the determination of the probable credit losses in the home equity portfolio. The modeled loss factor for the home equity portfolio is based on the trailing twelve month historical loss rate for each category, as adjusted for certain prescriptive loss rate factors and certain qualitative adjustment factors to reflect risks associated with current conditions and trends. The prescriptive loss rate factors include adjustments for delinquency trends, LTV trends, refreshed FICO score trends and product mix. The qualitative factors include adjustments for credit administration and portfolio management, credit policy and underwriting and the national and local economy. The Bancorp considers home price index trends when determining the national and local economy qualitative factor.

The home equity portfolio is managed in two primary groups: loans outstanding with a LTV greater than 80% and those loans with a LTV 80% or less based upon appraisals at origination. The carrying value of the greater than 80% LTV home equity loans and 80% or less LTV home equity loans were $3.1 billion and $6.0 billion, respectively, as of March 31, 2014. Of the total $9.1 billion of outstanding home equity loans:

 

   

83% reside within the Bancorp’s Midwest footprint of Ohio, Michigan, Kentucky, Indiana and Illinois;

 

   

34% are in senior lien positions and 66% are in junior lien positions at March 31, 2014;

 

   

Over 80% of non-delinquent borrowers made at least one payment greater than the minimum payment during the three months ended March 31, 2014; and

 

   

The portfolio had an average refreshed FICO score of 737 at March 31, 2014 and 736 at December 31, 2013.

The Bancorp actively manages lines of credit and makes reductions in lending limits when it believes it is necessary based on FICO score deterioration and property devaluation. The Bancorp does not routinely obtain appraisals on performing loans to update LTV ratios after origination. However, the Bancorp monitors the local housing markets by reviewing various home price indices and incorporates the impact of the changing market conditions in its ongoing credit monitoring processes. For junior lien home equity loans which become 60 days or more past due, the Bancorp tracks the performance of the senior lien loans in which the Bancorp is the servicer and utilizes consumer credit bureau attributes to monitor the status of the senior lien loans that the Bancorp does not service. If the senior lien loan is found to be 120 days or more past due, the junior lien home equity loan is placed on nonaccrual status unless both loans are well-secured and in the process of collection. Additionally, if the junior lien home equity loan becomes 120 days or more past due and the senior lien loan is also 120 days or more past due, the junior lien home equity loan is assessed for charge-off, unless it is well-secured and in the process of collection. Refer to the Analysis of Nonperforming Assets section of the MD&A for more information.

 

36


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

The following table provides an analysis of home equity loans outstanding disaggregated based upon refreshed FICO score:

TABLE 36: Home Equity Loans Outstanding by Refreshed FICO Score

 

     March 31, 2014     December 31, 2013  

($ in millions)

   Outstanding      % of
Total
    Outstanding      % of
Total
 

Senior Liens:

          

FICO < 620

   $ 195          $ 201       

FICO 621-719

     632        7       638        7  

FICO > 720

     2,240        25       2,253        24  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Senior Liens

     3,067        34       3,092        33  

Junior Liens:

          

FICO < 620

     553        6       565        6  

FICO 621-719

     1,619        18       1,662        18  

FICO > 720

     3,886        42       3,927        43  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Junior Liens

     6,058        66       6,154        67  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 9,125        100    $ 9,246        100 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Bancorp believes that home equity loans with a greater than 80% combined LTV ratio present a higher level of risk. The following table provides an analysis of the home equity loans outstanding in a senior and junior lien position by LTV at origination:

TABLE 37: Home Equity Loans Outstanding by LTV at Origination

 

     March 31, 2014     December 31, 2013  

($ in millions)

   Outstanding      Weighted
Average LTV
    Outstanding      Weighted
Average LTV
 

Senior Liens:

          

LTV £ 80%

   $ 2,629        55.1    $ 2,645        54.9 

LTV > 80%

     438        89.2       447        89.2  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Senior Liens

     3,067        60.1       3,092        60.1  

Junior Liens:

          

LTV £ 80%

     3,325        67.4       3,353        67.3  

LTV > 80%

     2,733        91.3       2,801        91.4  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Junior Liens

     6,058        80.1       6,154        80.2  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 9,125        72.8    $ 9,246        72.9 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following tables provide analysis of home equity loans by state with LTV greater than 80%:

TABLE 38: Home Equity Loans Outstanding with LTV Greater than 80%

 

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

                          For the three  months
ended March 31, 2014
 

By State:

   Outstanding      Exposure      90 Days
Past Due
and Accruing
     Nonaccrual(a)      Net Charge-offs(b)  

Ohio

   $ 1,146        1,863        —          9        2  

Michigan

     677        966        —          7        2  

Illinois

     371        543        —          5        2  

Indiana

     287        444        —          3        1  

Kentucky

     270        426        —          3        1  

Florida

     113        154        —          3        1  

All other states

     307        416        —          5        1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 3,171        4,812        —          35        10  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) During the fourth quarter of 2013, the Bancorp modified its nonaccrual policy for home equity loans and lines of credit. For further information, refer to Note 1 in the Bancorp’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013.
(b) During the fourth quarter of 2013, the Bancorp modified its charge-off policy for home equity loans and lines of credit. For further information, refer to Note 1 in the Bancorp’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013.

 

37


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

TABLE 39: Home Equity Loans Outstanding with LTV Greater than 80%

 

As of March 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

                          For the three months
ended  March 31, 2013
 

By State:

   Outstanding      Exposure      90 Days
Past Due
and Accruing
     Nonaccrual      Net Charge-offs  

Ohio

   $ 1,205        1,887        6        6        5  

Michigan

     768        1,081        5        3        5  

Illinois

     417        599        4        2        2  

Indiana

     333        506        3        2        1  

Kentucky

     312        485        2        1        1  

Florida

     127        171        2        3        1  

All other states

     356        477        3        3        3  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 3,518        5,206        25        20        18  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Automobile Portfolio

The automobile portfolio is characterized by direct and indirect lending products to consumers. As of March 31, 2014, 51% of the automobile loan portfolio is comprised of loans collateralized by new automobiles. It is a common practice to advance on automobile loans an amount in excess of the automobile value due to the inclusion of taxes, title, and other fees paid at closing. The Bancorp monitors its exposure to these higher risk loans.

The following table provides an analysis of automobile loans outstanding by LTV at origination:

TABLE 40: Automobile Loans Outstanding with LTV at Origination

 

     March 31, 2014     December 31, 2013  

($ in millions)

   Outstanding      Weighted
Average LTV
    Outstanding      Weighted
Average LTV
 

LTV £ 100%

   $ 8,384        81.4    $ 8,306        81.4 

LTV > 100%

     3,704        110.7       3,678        110.7  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 12,088        90.7    $ 11,984        90.7 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following tables provide analysis of the Bancorp’s automobile loans with a LTV at origination greater than 100%:

TABLE 41: Automobile Loans Outstanding with LTV Greater than 100%

 

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

                   For the three  months
ended March 31, 2014
 

By State:

   Outstanding      90 Days
Past Due
and Accruing
     Nonaccrual      Net Charge-offs  

Texas

   $ 410        —          —          1  

Ohio

     367        —          —          1  

Illinois

     194        —          —          —    

Florida

     192        —          —          —    

Michigan

     176        —          —          —    

Tennessee

     171        —          —          —    

All other states

     2,194        4        1        3  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 3,704        4        1        5  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

TABLE 42: Automobile Loans Outstanding with LTV Greater than 100%

 

As of March 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

                   For the three months
ended March 31, 2013
 

By State:

   Outstanding      90 Days
Past Due
and Accruing
     Nonaccrual      Net Charge-offs  

Texas

   $ 412        —          —          —    

Ohio

     393        —          —          —    

Illinois

     221        —          —          —    

Florida

     194        —          —          —    

Michigan

     212        —          —          —    

Tennessee

     175        —          —          —    

All other states

     2,179        4        1        3  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 3,786        4        1        3  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

European Exposure

The Bancorp has no direct sovereign exposure to any European nation as of March 31, 2014. In providing services to our customers, the Bancorp routinely enters into financial transactions with foreign domiciled and U.S. subsidiaries of foreign businesses as well as foreign financial institutions. These financial transactions are in the form of loans, loan commitments, letters of credit, derivatives and securities. The Bancorp’s risk appetite for foreign country exposure is managed by having established country exposure limits. The Bancorp’s total exposure to European domiciled or owned businesses and European financial institutions was $3.6 billion and funded exposure was $2.0 billion as of March 31, 2014. Additionally, the Bancorp was within its established country exposure limits for all European countries.

 

38


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Certain European countries have been experiencing increased levels of stress throughout 2013 and during the three months ended March 31, 2014 including Greece, Ireland, Italy, Portugal and Spain. The Bancorp’s total exposure to businesses domiciled or owned by companies and financial institutions in these countries was approximately $210 million and funded exposure was $108 million as of March 31, 2014.

The following table provides detail about the Bancorp’s exposure to all European domiciled and owned businesses and financial institutions as of March 31, 2014:

TABLE 43: European Exposure

 

     Sovereigns      Financial Institutions      Non-Financial
Institutions
     Total  

($ in millions)

   Total
Exposure
     Funded
Exposure
     Total
Exposure
     Funded
Exposure
     Total
Exposure
     Funded
Exposure
     Total
Exposure
(a)
    Funded
Exposure
 

Peripheral Europe(b)

   $ —          —          10        —          200        108        210       108  

Other Eurozone(c)

     —          —          72        28        2,294        1,381        2,366       1,409  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Eurozone

     —          —          82        28        2,494        1,489        2,576       1,517  

Other Europe(d)

     —          —          80        19        952        500        1,032       519  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Europe

   $ —          —          162        47        3,446        1,989        3,608 (e)       2,036  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Total exposure includes funded exposure and unfunded commitments, reported net of collateral.
(b) Peripheral Europe includes Greece, Ireland, Italy, Portugal and Spain.
(c) Eurozone includes countries participating in the European common currency (Euro).
(d) Other Europe includes European countries not part of the Euro (primarily the United Kingdom and Switzerland).
(e) Includes $1,482 related to U.S. based customers owned by European entities.

Analysis of Nonperforming Assets

Nonperforming assets include nonaccrual loans and leases for which ultimate collectability of the full amount of the principal and/or interest is uncertain; restructured commercial and credit card loans which have not yet met the requirements to be classified as a performing asset; restructured consumer loans which are 90 days past due based on the restructured terms unless the loan is both well-secured and in the process of collection; and certain other assets, including OREO and other repossessed property. A summary of nonperforming assets is included in Table 44. Refer to the nonaccrual section of Note 1 in the Bancorp’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013 for additional delinquency and nonperforming information.

Total nonperforming assets, including loans held for sale, were $949 million at March 31, 2014 compared to $986 million at December 31, 2013. At March 31, 2014, $3 million of nonaccrual loans, consisting primarily of real estate secured loans, were held for sale, compared to $6 million at December 31, 2013.

Nonperforming assets as a percentage of total loans, leases and other assets, including OREO and nonaccrual loans held for sale as of March 31, 2014 were 1.05%, compared to 1.10% as of December 31, 2013. The composition of nonaccrual loans and leases continues to be concentrated in real estate as 57% of nonaccrual loans and leases were secured by real estate as of March 31, 2014 compared with 60% as of December 31, 2013.

Commercial nonperforming loans and leases were $467 million at March 31, 2014, an increase of $3 million from December 31, 2013. Excluding commercial nonperforming loans and leases held for sale, commercial nonperforming loans and leases at March 31, 2014 increased $6 million compared to December 31, 2013 as new nonaccruals slightly outpaced loan paydowns/payoffs and charge-offs.

Consumer nonperforming loans and leases were $269 million at March 31, 2014, a decrease of $24 million from December 31, 2013. The decrease is primarily due to residential mortgage loan transfers to performing and OREO which outpaced paydowns/payoffs of on new residential mortgage nonaccrual loans. Geographical market conditions continue to be a large driver of nonaccrual activity as Florida properties represent approximately 13% and 8% of residential mortgage and home equity balances, respectively, but represent 37% and 15% of nonaccrual loans for each category. Refer to Table 45 for a rollforward of the nonperforming loans and leases.

OREO and other repossessed property was $213 million at March 31, 2014 compared to $229 million at December 31, 2013. The Bancorp recognized $13 million and $22 million in losses on the sale or write-down of OREO properties for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The decrease from the first quarter of 2013 was primarily due to a modest improvement in general economic conditions partially offset by a $6 million write-down on one commercial OREO property recognized in the first quarter of 2014.

For the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, approximately $13 million and $20 million, respectively, of interest income would have been recognized if the nonaccrual and renegotiated loans and leases on nonaccrual status had been current in accordance with their original terms. Although these values help demonstrate the costs of carrying nonaccrual credits, the Bancorp does not expect to recover the full amount of interest as nonaccrual loans and leases are generally carried below their principal balance.

 

39


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

TABLE 44: Summary of Nonperforming Assets and Delinquent Loans

 

($ in millions)

   March 31, 2014     December 31, 2013  

Nonaccrual loans and leases:

    

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 153       127  

Commercial mortgage loans

     96       90  

Commercial construction loans

     3       10  

Commercial leases

     3       3  

Residential mortgage loans

     68       83  

Home equity

     75       74  

Restructured loans and leases:

    

Commercial and industrial loans

     144       154  

Commercial mortgage loans(e)

     50       53  

Commercial construction loans

     14       19  

Commercial leases

     1       2  

Residential mortgage loans

     73       83  

Home equity

     19       19  

Automobile loans

     1       1  

Credit card

     33       33  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total nonperforming loans and leases(d)

     733       751  

OREO and other repossessed property(c)

     213       229  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total nonperforming assets

     946       980  

Nonaccrual loans held for sale

     3       6  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total nonperforming assets including loans held for sale

   $ 949       986  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans and leases 90 days past due and accruing

    

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 1       —    

Residential mortgage loans(b)

     56       66  

Automobile loans

     7       8  

Credit card

     30       29  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total loans and leases 90 days past due and accruing

   $ 94       103  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Nonperforming assets as a percent of portfolio loans, leases and other assets, including OREO(a)

     1.05     1.10  

Allowance for loan and lease losses as a percent of nonperforming assets(a)

     157       161  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Excludes nonaccrual loans held for sale.
(b) Information for all periods presented excludes loans whose repayments are insured by the Federal Housing Administration or guaranteed by the Department of Veterans Affairs. These loans were $347 as of March 31, 2014 and $378 as of December 31, 2013. The Bancorp recognized $5 and immaterial credit losses for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and March 31, 2013, respectively.
(c) Excludes $85 and $77 of OREO related to government insured loans at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.
(d) Includes $9 and $10 of nonaccrual government insured commercial loans whose repayments are insured by the SBA at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, and $2 of restructured nonaccrual government insured commercial loans at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.
(e) Excludes $21 of restructured nonaccrual loans at both March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, associated with a consolidated variable interest entity in which the Bancorp has no continuing credit risk due to the risk being assumed by a third party.

 

40


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

The following table provides a rollforward of portfolio nonperforming loans and leases, by portfolio segment:

TABLE 45: Rollforward of Portfolio Nonperforming Loans and Leases

 

For the three months ended March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

   Commercial     Residential
Mortgage
    Consumer     Total  

Beginning Balance

   $ 458       166       127       751  

Transfers to nonperforming

     164       36       57       257  

Transfers to performing

     (2     (10     (18     (30

Transfers to performing (restructured)

     (1     (10     (12     (23

Loans sold from portfolio

     (2     —         —         (2

Loan paydowns/payoffs

     (43     (30     1       (72

Transfers to other real estate owned

     (7     (20     (4     (31

(Charge-offs) recoveries

     (105     9       (24     (120

Draws/other extensions of credit

     2       —         1       3  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending Balance

   $ 464       141       128       733  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

For the three months ended March 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

                        

Beginning Balance

   $ 697       237       95       1,029  

Transfers to nonperforming

     80       51       73       204  

Transfers to performing

     (1     (9     (17     (27

Transfers to performing (restructured)

     (4     (11     (18     (33

Transfers to held for sale

     (1     —         —         (1

Loans sold from portfolio

     (3     —         —         (3

Loan paydowns/payoffs

     (53     (23     (4     (80

Transfers to other real estate owned

     (27     (17     —         (44

Charge-offs

     (54     (7     (39     (100

Draws/other extensions of credit

     5       —         1       6  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending Balance

   $ 639       221       91       951  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Troubled Debt Restructurings

If a borrower is experiencing financial difficulty, the Bancorp may consider, in certain circumstances, modifying the terms of their loan to maximize collection of amounts due. Typically, these modifications reduce the loan interest rate, extend the loan term, reduce the accrued interest or in limited circumstances, reduce the principal balance of the loan. These modifications are classified as TDRs.

At the time of modification, the Bancorp maintains certain consumer loan TDRs (including residential mortgage loans, home equity loans, and other consumer loans) on accrual status, provided there is reasonable assurance of repayment and performance according to the modified terms based upon a current, well-documented credit evaluation. Commercial loans modified as part of a TDR are maintained on accrual status provided there is a sustained payment history of six months or greater prior to the modification in accordance with the modified terms and all remaining contractual payments under the modified terms are reasonably assured of collection. TDRs of commercial loans and credit card loans that do not have a sustained payment history of six months or greater in accordance with the modified terms remain on nonaccrual status until a six-month payment history is sustained.

Consumer restructured loans on accrual status totaled $1.7 billion at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013. As of March 31, 2014, the percentage of restructured residential mortgage loans, home equity loans, and credit card loans that are past due 30 days or more were 19%, 11% and 18%, respectively.

The following table summarizes TDRs by loan type and delinquency status:

TABLE 46: Performing and Nonperforming TDRs

 

      Performing                

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

   Current      30-89 Days
Past Due
     90 Days or
More Past Due
     Nonaccrual      Total  

Commercial(b)(c)

   $ 847        —          —          209        1,056  

Residential mortgages(a)

     1,059        75        103        73        1,310  

Home equity

     357        26        —          19        402  

Credit card

     24        —          —          33        57  

Automobile and other consumer loans and leases

     22        1        —          1        24  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 2,309        102        103        335        2,849  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Information includes loans whose repayments are insured by the Federal Housing Administration or guaranteed by the Department of Veterans Affairs. As of March 31, 2014, these loans represented $179 of current loans, $30 of 30-89 days past due loans and $81 of 90 days or more past due loans.
(b) Excludes $7 of restructured accruing loans and $21 of restructured nonaccrual loans associated with a consolidated variable interest entity in which the Bancorp has no continuing credit risk due to the risk being assumed by a third party.
(c) Excludes restructured nonaccrual loans held for sale.

 

41


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

      Performing                

As of March 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

   Current      30-89 Days
Past Due
     90 Days or
More Past Due
     Nonaccrual      Total  

Commercial(b)(c)

   $ 439        2        —          159        600  

Residential mortgages(a)

     1,029        69        103        111        1,312  

Home equity

     389        30        —          22        441  

Credit card

     32        —          —          39        71  

Automobile and other consumer loans and leases

     29        2        —          2        33  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,918        103        103        333        2,457  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Information includes loans whose repayments are insured by the Federal Housing Administration or guaranteed by the Department of Veterans Affairs. As of March 31, 2013, these loans represented $127 of current loans, $25 of 30-89 days past due loans and $84 of 90 days or more past due loans.
(b) Excludes $8 of restructured accruing loans and $22 of restructured nonaccrual loans associated with a consolidated variable interest entity in which the Bancorp has no continuing credit risk due to the risk being assumed by a third party.
(c) Excludes restructured nonaccrual loans held for sale.

Analysis of Net Loan Charge-offs

Net charge-offs were 76 bps and 63 bps of average portfolio loans and leases for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Table 47 provides a summary of credit loss experience and net charge-offs as a percentage of average portfolio loans and leases outstanding by loan category.

The ratio of commercial loan and lease net charge-offs to average portfolio commercial loans and leases increased to 79 bps during the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to 44 bps during the three months ended March 31, 2013. The increase is a result of increases in net charge-offs of $51 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 from the same period in the prior year partially offset by an increase in the average portfolio commercial loan and lease balance of $3.5 billion. Increases in net charge-offs were realized on commercial and industrial loans and were primarily due to three large credits which experienced combined charge-offs of $60 million during the first quarter of 2014. The increase in commercial and industrial loan net charge-offs was partially offset by decreases in commercial mortgage net charge-offs primarily due to improvements in general economic conditions and previous actions taken by the Bancorp to address problem loans. Among several actions taken by the Bancorp were suspending homebuilder and developer lending in 2007 and non-owner occupied commercial real estate lending in 2008 and tightened underwriting standards across all commercial loan product offerings. The Bancorp resumed homebuilder and developer lending and non-owner occupied commercial real estate lending in the third quarter of 2011. Net charge-offs for the three months ended March 31, 2014 related to non-owner occupied commercial real estate were $1 million compared to $16 million for the three months ended March 31, 2013. Net charge-offs related to non-owner occupied commercial real estate are recorded in the commercial mortgage loans and commercial construction loans captions in Table 47. Net charge-offs on these loans represented 1% and 30% of total commercial loan and lease net charge-offs for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

The ratio of consumer loan and lease net charge-offs to average portfolio consumer loans and leases decreased to 72 bps during the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to 89 bps during the three months ended March 31, 2013. Residential mortgage loan net charge-offs, which typically involve partial charge-offs based upon appraised values of underlying collateral, decreased $5 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period from the prior year as a result of improvements in delinquencies and a decrease in the average loss recorded per charge-off. The Bancorp’s combined Florida and Michigan markets accounted for 25% and 52% of net charge-offs on residential mortgage loans in the portfolio during the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Bancorp expects the composition of the residential mortgage portfolio to improve as it continues to retain high quality, shorter duration residential mortgage loans that are originated through its branch network as a low-cost, refinance product of conforming residential mortgage loans.

Home equity net charge-offs decreased $14 million compared to the three months ended March 31, 2013, primarily due to improvements in loss severities and delinquencies. In addition, management actively manages lines of credit and makes reductions in lending limits when it believes it is necessary based on FICO score deterioration or property devaluation.

Credit card and other consumer loan net charge-offs remained relatively flat compared to the same period in the prior year. The Bancorp utilizes a risk-adjusted pricing methodology to ensure adequate compensation is received for those products that have higher credit costs.

 

42


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

TABLE 47: Summary of Credit Loss Experience

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Losses charged off:

    

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ (100     (35

Commercial mortgage loans

     (5     (29

Commercial construction loans

     (5     (4

Residential mortgage loans

     (19     (22

Home equity

     (20     (34

Automobile loans

     (12     (12

Credit card

     (22     (23

Other consumer loans and leases

     (7     (9
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total losses

     (190     (168

Recoveries of losses previously charged off:

    

Commercial and industrial loans

     3       10  

Commercial mortgage loans

     2       3  

Commercial construction loans

     —         1  

Residential mortgage loans

     4       2  

Home equity

     4       4  

Automobile loans

     4       8  

Credit card

     3       3  

Other consumer loans and leases

     2       4  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total recoveries

     22       35  

Net losses charged off:

    

Commercial and industrial loans

     (97     (25

Commercial mortgage loans

     (3     (26

Commercial construction loans

     (5     (3

Residential mortgage loans

     (15     (20

Home equity

     (16     (30

Automobile loans

     (8     (4

Credit card

     (19     (20

Other consumer loans and leases

     (5     (5
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net losses charged off

   $ (168     (133
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net charge-offs as a percent of average loans and leases (excluding held for sale):

    

Commercial and industrial loans

     0.97      0.28  

Commercial mortgage loans

     0.16       1.18  

Commercial construction loans

     1.66       1.44  

Commercial leases

     (0.03     0.03  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total commercial loans

     0.79       0.44  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Residential mortgage loans

     0.49       0.69  

Home equity

     0.72       1.23  

Automobile loans

     0.29       0.16  

Credit card

     3.41       3.82  

Other consumer loans and leases

     6.58       6.61  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total consumer loans and leases

     0.72       0.89  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net losses charged off

     0.76      0.63  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Allowance for Credit Losses

The allowance for credit losses is comprised of the ALLL and the reserve for unfunded commitments. The ALLL provides coverage for probable and estimable losses in the loan and lease portfolio. The Bancorp evaluates the ALLL each quarter to determine its adequacy to cover inherent losses. Several factors are taken into consideration in the determination of the overall ALLL, including an unallocated component. These factors include, but are not limited to, the overall risk profile of the loan and lease portfolios, net charge-off experience, the extent of impaired loans and leases, the level of nonaccrual loans and leases, the level of 90 days past due loans and leases and the overall percentage level of the ALLL. The Bancorp also considers overall asset quality trends, credit administration and portfolio management practices, risk identification practices, credit policy and underwriting practices, overall portfolio growth, portfolio concentrations and current national and local economic conditions that might impact the portfolio. More information on the ALLL can be found in Management’s Discussion and Analysis — Critical Accounting Policies in the Bancorp’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013.

During the three months ended March 31, 2014, the Bancorp did not substantively change any material aspect of its overall approach in the determination of the ALLL and there have been no material changes in assumptions or estimation techniques as compared to prior periods that impacted the determination of the current period allowance. In addition to the ALLL, the Bancorp maintains a reserve for unfunded commitments recorded in other liabilities in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. The methodology used to determine the adequacy of this reserve is similar to the Bancorp’s methodology for determining the ALLL. The provision for unfunded commitments is included in other noninterest expense in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income.

 

43


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

The ALLL attributable to the portion of the residential mortgage and consumer loan and lease portfolio that has not been restructured is determined on a pooled basis with the segmentation being based on the similarity of credit risk characteristics. Loss factors for real estate backed consumer loans are developed for each pool based on the trailing twelve month historical loss rate, as adjusted for certain prescriptive loss rate factors and certain qualitative adjustment factors. The prescriptive loss rate factors and qualitative adjustments are designed to reflect risks associated with current conditions and trends which are not believed to be fully reflected in the trailing twelve month historical loss rate. For real estate backed consumer loans, the prescriptive loss rate factors include adjustments for delinquency trends, LTV trends, refreshed FICO score trends and product mix, and the qualitative factors include adjustments for credit administration and portfolio management practices, credit policy and underwriting practices and the national and local economy. The Bancorp considers home price index trends in its footprint when determining the national and local economy qualitative factor. The Bancorp also considers the volatility of collateral valuation trends when determining the unallocated component of the ALLL.

The Bancorp’s determination of the ALLL for commercial loans is sensitive to the risk grades it assigns to these loans. In the event that 10% of commercial loans in each risk category would experience a downgrade of one risk category, the allowance for commercial loans would increase by approximately $158 million at March 31, 2014. In addition, the Bancorp’s determination of the allowance for residential and consumer loans is sensitive to changes in estimated loss rates. In the event that estimated loss rates would increase by 10%, the allowance for residential and consumer loans would increase by approximately $40 million at March 31, 2014. As several qualitative and quantitative factors are considered in determining the ALLL, these sensitivity analyses do not necessarily reflect the nature and extent of future changes in the ALLL. They are intended to provide insights into the impact of adverse changes to risk grades and estimated loss rates and do not imply any expectation of future deterioration in the risk ratings or loss rates. Given current processes employed by the Bancorp, management believes the risk grades and estimated loss rates currently assigned are appropriate.

TABLE 48: Changes in Allowance for Credit Losses

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

ALLL:

    

Balance, beginning of period

   $ 1,582       1,854  

Losses charged off

     (190     (168

Recoveries of losses previously charged off

     22       35  

Provision for loan and lease losses

     69       62  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

   $ 1,483       1,783  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reserve for unfunded commitments:

    

Balance, beginning of period

   $ 162       179  

Benefit for unfunded commitments

     (9     (11
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

   $ 153       168  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Certain inherent but unconfirmed losses are probable within the loan and lease portfolio. The Bancorp’s current methodology for determining the level of losses is based on historical loss rates, current credit grades, specific allocation on impaired commercial credits above specified thresholds and restructured residential mortgage and consumer loans and other qualitative adjustments. Due to the heavy reliance on realized historical losses and the credit grade rating process, the model-derived estimate of ALLL tends to slightly lag behind the deterioration in the portfolio in a stable or deteriorating credit environment, and tend not to be as responsive when improved conditions have presented themselves. Given these model limitations, the qualitative adjustment factors may be incremental or decremental to the quantitative model results.

An unallocated component to the ALLL is maintained to recognize the imprecision in estimating and measuring loss. The unallocated allowance as a percent of total portfolio loans and leases was 0.12% at both March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013. The unallocated allowance was seven percent of the total allowance as of both March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

As shown in Table 49, the ALLL as a percent of portfolio loan and leases was 1.65% at March 31, 2014 compared to 1.79% at December 31, 2013. The ALLL was $1.5 billion as of March 31, 2014 compared to $1.6 billion as of December 31, 2013. The decrease from December 31, 2013 is reflective of decreases in nonperforming loans and leases and improved delinquency metrics in commercial and consumer loans and leases.

 

44


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

TABLE 49: Attribution of Allowance for Loan and Lease Losses to Portfolio Loans and Leases

 

($ in millions)

   March 31, 2014     December 31, 2013  

Allowance attributed to:

    

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 719       767  

Commercial mortgage loans

     191       212  

Commercial construction loans

     23       26  

Commercial leases

     48       53  

Residential mortgage loans

     180       189  

Home equity

     86       94  

Automobile loans

     28       23  

Credit card

     90       92  

Other consumer loans and leases

     13       16  

Unallocated

     105       110  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total ALLL

   $ 1,483       1,582  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Portfolio loans and leases:

    

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 40,591       39,316  

Commercial mortgage loans

     7,958       8,066  

Commercial construction loans

     1,218       1,039  

Commercial leases

     3,577       3,625  

Residential mortgage loans

     12,626       12,680  

Home equity

     9,125       9,246  

Automobile loans

     12,088       11,984  

Credit card

     2,177       2,294  

Other consumer loans and leases

     345       364  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total portfolio loans and leases

   $ 89,705       88,614  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Attributed allowance as a percent of respective portfolio loans and leases:

    

Commercial and industrial loans

     1.77      1.95  

Commercial mortgage loans

     2.40       2.63  

Commercial construction loans

     1.89       2.50  

Commercial leases

     1.34       1.46  

Residential mortgage loans

     1.43       1.49  

Home equity

     0.94       1.02  

Automobile loans

     0.23       0.19  

Credit card

     4.13       4.01  

Other consumer loans and leases

     3.77       4.40  

Unallocated (as a percent of total portfolio loans and leases)

     0.12       0.12  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Attributed allowance as a percent of total portfolio loans and leases

     1.65      1.79  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

MARKET RISK MANAGEMENT

Market risk arises from the potential for market fluctuations in interest rates, foreign exchange rates and equity prices that may result in potential reductions in net income. Interest rate risk, a component of market risk, is the exposure to adverse changes in net interest income or financial position due to changes in interest rates. Management considers interest rate risk a prominent market risk in terms of its potential impact on earnings. Interest rate risk can occur for any one or more of the following reasons:

 

   

Assets and liabilities may mature or reprice at different times;

 

   

Short-term and long-term market interest rates may change by different amounts; or

 

   

The expected maturity of various assets or liabilities may shorten or lengthen as interest rates change.

In addition to the direct impact of interest rate changes on net interest income, interest rates can indirectly impact earnings through their effect on loan demand, credit losses, mortgage originations, the value of servicing rights and other sources of the Bancorp’s earnings. Stability of the Bancorp’s net income is largely dependent upon the effective management of interest rate risk. Management continually reviews the Bancorp’s balance sheet composition and earnings flows and models the interest rate risk, and possible actions to reduce this risk, given numerous possible future interest rate scenarios.

Interest Rate Risk Management Oversight

The Bancorp’s Executive ALCO, which includes senior management representatives and is accountable to the ERM Committee, monitors and manages interest rate risk within Board approved policy limits. In addition to the risk management activities of ALCO, the Bancorp has a Market Risk Management function as part of ERM that provides independent oversight of market risk activities.

Net Interest Income Sensitivity

The Bancorp utilizes a variety of measurement techniques to identify and manage its interest rate risk, including the use of an NII simulation model to analyze the sensitivity of net interest income to changing interest rates. The model is based on contractual and assumed cash flows and repricing characteristics for all of the Bancorp’s assets, liabilities and off-balance sheet exposures and incorporates market-based assumptions regarding the effect of changing interest rates on the prepayment rates of certain assets and attrition rates for certain liabilities. The model also includes senior management’s projections of the future volume and pricing of each of the product lines offered by the Bancorp as well as other pertinent assumptions. Actual results may differ from these simulated results due to timing, magnitude and frequency of interest rate changes as well as changes in market conditions and management strategies.

 

45


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

The Bancorp’s interest rate risk exposure is currently evaluated by measuring the anticipated change in net interest income over 12-month and 24-month horizons assuming 100 bps and 200 bps parallel ramped increases in interest rates. The analysis would typically include 100 bps and 200 bps parallel ramped decreases in interest rates; however, this analysis is currently omitted due to the current low levels of short-term interest rates. Applying the ramps would result in certain short-term interest rates becoming negative in the parallel ramped decrease scenarios. In accordance with the current policy, the rate movements are assumed to occur over one year and are sustained thereafter.

The following table shows the Bancorp’s estimated net interest income sensitivity profile and ALCO policy limits as of:

TABLE 50: Estimated NII Sensitivity Profile

 

     March 31, 2014     March 31, 2013  
     % Change in NII (FTE)      ALCO Policy Limits     % Change in NII (FTE)      ALCO Policy Limits  

Change in Interest Rates (bps)

   12 Months     13 to 24
Months
     12 Months     13 to 24
Months
    12 Months     13 to 24
Months
     12 Months     13 to 24
Months
 

+ 200

     2.01      7.21        (4.00     (6.00     2.30      8.23        (4.00     (6.00

+ 100

     0.99       4.07        —         —         1.19       4.20        —         —    

At March 31, 2014, the Bancorp’s net interest income would benefit in year one and year two due to these parallel ramp increases. The benefit is attributable to the combination of floating-rate assets, including the predominantly floating-rate commercial loan portfolio, and certain intermediate-term fixed rate liabilities. The benefit is down modestly when compared to March 31, 2013. The lower net interest income benefit is attributable to an increase in fixed-rate securities balances and the realization of slower prepayments on the available-for-sale security portfolio over the past year. At March 31, 2013, prepayments speeds on certain available-for-sale securities were projected to slow in a rising rate environment, which provided a benefit to net interest income sensitivity at that time. In 2013, these slowing prepayments were realized as a result of an increase in the level of market interest rates and mortgage rates. Further increases in interest rates will not have the same impact on net interest income, which results in a modest reduction in the benefit. The impacts of the slowing prepayments and the increase in the fixed-rate securities portfolio were partly offset by an increase in core deposit balances and an increase in actual and projected fixed-rate borrowings and shareholders’ equity.

Economic Value of Equity Sensitivity

The Bancorp also utilizes EVE as a measurement tool in managing interest rate risk. Whereas the net interest income sensitivity analysis highlights the impact on forecasted NII over 1- and 2-year time horizons, the EVE analysis is a point in time analysis of the current positions and incorporates all cash flows over their estimated remaining lives. The EVE of the balance sheet is defined as the discounted present value of all remaining asset and net derivative cash flows less the discounted value of all remaining liability cash flows. Due to this longer horizon, the sensitivity of EVE to changes in the level of interest rates is a measure of longer-term interest rate risk. EVE values only the current balance sheet and does not incorporate the growth assumptions used in the NII sensitivity analysis. As with the NII simulation model, assumptions about the timing and variability of existing balance sheet cash flows are critical in the EVE analysis. Particularly important are assumptions driving loan and security prepayments and the expected balance attrition and pricing of transaction deposits.

The following table shows the Bancorp’s EVE sensitivity profile as of:

TABLE 51: Estimated EVE Sensitivity Profile

 

     March 31, 2014     March 31, 2013  

Change in Interest Rates (bps)

   Change in EVE     ALCO Policy Limit     Change in EVE     ALCO Policy Limit  

+ 200

     (3.72 )%      (12.00     0.21      (12.00

+ 100

     (1.72       0.64    

+ 25

     (0.37       0.30    

- 25

     0.39         (0.50  

At March 31, 2014, the EVE sensitivity is modestly negative, compared to a neutral position at March 31, 2013. The primary factors contributing to the change are an increase in the average life of mortgage loans and securities positions as a result of slowing prepayments due to increases in the levels of market interest rates and mortgage rates, growth in fixed-rate securities balances, and a decreased benefit related to MSRs. At March 31, 2013, the MSR valuation was projected to benefit from slowing prepayments that would occur with rising interest rates. Slowing prepayments were realized during 2013 due to increased market rates, and consequently, future increases in interest rates will have a smaller benefit to the MSR valuation.

While an instantaneous shift in interest rates is used in this analysis to provide an estimate of exposure, the Bancorp believes that a gradual shift in interest rates would have a much more modest impact. Since EVE measures the discounted present value of cash flows over the estimated lives of instruments, the change in EVE does not directly correlate to the degree that earnings would be impacted over a shorter time horizon (e.g., the current fiscal year). Further, EVE does not take into account factors such as future balance sheet growth, changes in product mix, changes in yield curve relationships and changing product spreads that could mitigate or exacerbate the impact of changes in interest rates. The NII simulations and EVE analyses do not necessarily include certain actions that management may undertake to manage risk in response to anticipated changes in interest rates.

 

46


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

The Bancorp regularly evaluates its exposures to LIBOR and Prime basis risks, nonparallel shifts in the yield curve and embedded options risk. In addition, the impact on NII and EVE of extreme changes in interest rates is modeled, wherein the Bancorp employs the use of yield curve shocks and environment-specific scenarios.

Use of Derivatives to Manage Interest Rate Risk

An integral component of the Bancorp’s interest rate risk management strategy is its use of derivative instruments to minimize significant fluctuations in earnings caused by changes in market interest rates. Examples of derivative instruments that the Bancorp may use as part of its interest rate risk management strategy include interest rate swaps, interest rate floors, interest rate caps, forward contracts, options, swaptions and TBA securities.

As part of its overall risk management strategy relative to its mortgage banking activity, the Bancorp enters into forward contracts accounted for as free-standing derivatives to economically hedge interest rate lock commitments that are also considered free-standing derivatives. Additionally, the Bancorp economically hedges its exposure to mortgage loans held for sale through the use of forward contracts and mortgage options.

The Bancorp also establishes derivative contracts with major financial institutions to economically hedge significant exposures assumed in commercial customer accommodation derivative contracts. Generally, these contracts have similar terms in order to protect the Bancorp from market volatility. Credit risk arises from the possible inability of counterparties to meet the terms of their contracts, which the Bancorp minimizes through collateral arrangements, approvals, limits and monitoring procedures. For further information including the notional amount and fair values of these derivatives, see Note 10 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

Portfolio Loans and Leases and Interest Rate Risk

Although the Bancorp’s portfolio loans and leases contain both fixed and floating/adjustable rate products, the rates of interest earned by the Bancorp on the outstanding balances are generally established for a period of time. The interest rate sensitivity of loans and leases is directly related to the length of time the rate earned is established. The following table summarizes the expected cash flows of the carrying value of the Bancorp’s portfolio loans and leases as of March 31, 2014:

TABLE 52: Portfolio Loan and Lease Expected Maturities

 

($ in millions)

   Less than 1 year      1-5 years      Over 5 years      Total  

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 18,716        20,884        991        40,591  

Commercial mortgage loans

     3,557        3,940        461        7,958  

Commercial construction loans

     535        655        28        1,218  

Commercial leases

     675        1,583        1,319        3,577  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Subtotal - commercial loans and leases

     23,483        27,062        2,799        53,344  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Residential mortgage loans

     2,268        4,818        5,540        12,626  

Home equity

     1,172        3,389        4,564        9,125  

Automobile loans

     5,211        6,758        119        12,088  

Credit card

     628        1,549        —          2,177  

Other consumer loans and leases

     331        13        1        345  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Subtotal - consumer loans and leases

     9,610        16,527        10,224        36,361  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 33,093        43,589        13,023        89,705  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Additionally, the following table displays a summary of expected cash flows, excluding interest receivable, occurring after one year for both fixed and floating/adjustable rate loans and leases as of March 31, 2014:

TABLE 53: Portfolio Loan and Lease Cash Flows Occurring After One Year

 

     Interest Rate  

($ in millions)

   Fixed      Floating or Adjustable  

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 2,598        19,277  

Commercial mortgage loans

     1,173        3,228  

Commercial construction loans

     26        657  

Commercial leases

     2,902        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Subtotal - commercial loans and leases

     6,699        23,162  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Residential mortgage loans

     7,964        2,394  

Home equity

     840        7,113  

Automobile loans

     6,837        40  

Credit card

     604        945  

Other consumer loans and leases

     1        13  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Subtotal - consumer loans and leases

     16,246        10,505  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 22,945        33,667  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Residential Mortgage Servicing Rights and Interest Rate Risk

The net carrying amount of the residential MSR portfolio was $972 million and $967 million as of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. The value of servicing rights can fluctuate sharply depending on changes in interest rates and other factors. Generally, as interest rates decline and loans are prepaid to take advantage of refinancing, the total value of existing servicing rights declines because no further servicing fees are collected on repaid loans. The Bancorp maintains a non-qualifying hedging strategy relative to its mortgage banking activity in order to manage a portion of the risk associated with changes in the value of its MSR portfolio as a result of changing interest rates.

 

47


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Actual prepayments on the servicing portfolio continued to decline during the three months ended March 31, 2014 from the three months ended March 31, 2013. This caused modeled prepayment speeds to slow, which led to a recovery of $4 million of temporary impairment on servicing rights during the three months ended March 31, 2014. Mortgage rates increased slightly during the first quarter of 2013 causing modeled prepayment speeds to slow, which led to a recovery of $49 million of temporary impairment on servicing rights during the three months ended March 31, 2013. Servicing rights are deemed temporarily impaired when a borrower’s loan rate is distinctly higher than prevailing rates. Temporary impairment on servicing rights is reversed when the prevailing rates return to a level commensurate with the borrower’s loan rate. In addition to the mortgage servicing rights valuation, the Bancorp recognized net gains of $24 million on its non-qualifying hedging strategy for the three months ended March 31, 2014, compared to net losses of $4 million for the three months ended March 31, 2013. These amounts include net gains on securities related to the Bancorp’s non-qualifying hedging strategy which were zero in the first quarter of 2014 and $2 million in the first quarter of 2013. The Bancorp may adjust its hedging strategy to reflect its assessment of the composition of its MSR portfolio, the cost of hedging and the anticipated effectiveness of the hedges given the economic environment. See Note 9 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion on servicing rights and the instruments used to hedge interest rate risk on MSRs.

Foreign Currency Risk

The Bancorp may enter into foreign exchange derivative contracts to economically hedge certain foreign denominated loans. The derivatives are classified as free-standing instruments with the revaluation gain or loss being recorded in other noninterest income in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income. The balance of the Bancorp’s foreign denominated loans at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013 was $631 million and $581 million, respectively. The Bancorp also enters into foreign exchange contracts for the benefit of commercial customers involved in international trade to hedge their exposure to foreign currency fluctuations. The Bancorp has internal controls in place to help ensure excessive risk is not being taken in providing this service to customers. These controls include an independent determination of currency volatility and credit equivalent exposure on these contracts, counterparty credit approvals and country limits.

LIQUIDITY RISK MANAGEMENT

The goal of liquidity management is to provide adequate funds to meet changes in loan and lease demand, unexpected levels of deposit withdrawals and other contractual obligations. Mitigating liquidity risk is accomplished by maintaining liquid assets in the form of investment securities, maintaining sufficient unused borrowing capacity in the debt markets and delivering consistent growth in core deposits. A summary of certain obligations and commitments to make future payments under contracts is included in Note 14 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

The Bancorp maintains a contingency funding plan that assesses the liquidity needs under various scenarios of market conditions, asset growth and credit rating downgrades. The plan includes liquidity stress testing which measures various sources and uses of funds under the different scenarios. The contingency plan provides for ongoing monitoring of unused borrowing capacity and available sources of contingent liquidity to prepare for unexpected liquidity needs and to cover unanticipated events that could affect liquidity.

Sources of Funds

The Bancorp’s primary sources of funds relate to cash flows from loan and lease repayments, payments from securities related to sales and maturities, the sale or securitization of loans and leases and funds generated by core deposits, in addition to the use of public and private debt offerings.

Projected contractual maturities from loan and lease repayments are included in Table 52 of the Market Risk Management section of MD&A. Of the $20.7 billion of securities in the Bancorp’s available-for-sale and other portfolio at March 31, 2014, $3.0 billion in principal and interest is expected to be received in the next 12 months and an additional $2.4 billion is expected to be received in the next 13 to 24 months. For further information on the Bancorp’s securities portfolio, see the Investment Securities section of MD&A.

Asset-driven liquidity is provided by the Bancorp’s ability to sell or securitize loan and lease assets. In order to reduce the exposure to interest rate fluctuations and to manage liquidity, the Bancorp has developed securitization and sale procedures for several types of interest-sensitive assets. A majority of the long-term, fixed-rate single-family residential mortgage loans underwritten according to FHLMC or FNMA guidelines are sold for cash upon origination. Additional assets such as residential mortgages, certain commercial loans, home equity loans, automobile loans and other consumer loans are also capable of being securitized or sold. For the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, the Bancorp sold or securitized loans totaling $2.9 billion and $7.4 billion, respectively. For further information on the transfer of financial assets, see Note 9 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

Core deposits have historically provided the Bancorp with a sizeable source of relatively stable and low cost funds. The Bancorp’s average core deposits and shareholders’ equity funded 83% of its average total assets for the first quarter of 2014 and 81% for the first quarter of 2013. In addition to core deposit funding, the Bancorp also accesses a variety of other short-term and long-term funding sources, which include the use of the FHLB system. Certificates of deposit carrying a balance of $100,000 or more and deposits in the Bancorp’s foreign branch located in the Cayman Islands are wholesale funding tools utilized to fund asset growth. Management does not rely on any one source of liquidity and manages availability in response to changing balance sheet needs.

 

48


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

As of March 31, 2014, $3.3 billion of debt or other securities were available for issuance under the current Bancorp’s Board of Directors’ authorizations and the Bancorp is authorized to file any necessary registration statements with the SEC to permit ready access to the public securities markets; however, access to these markets may depend on market conditions. On February 25, 2014, the Bancorp issued and sold $500 million of 2.30% unsecured senior fixed rate notes. Additionally, the Bancorp has approximately $39.1 billion of borrowing capacity available through secured borrowing sources including the FHLB and FRB.

In 2013, the Bancorp’s banking subsidiary updated and amended its existing global bank note program to increase the capacity from $20 billion to $25 billion. The Bancorp has $21.5 billion of funding available for issuance under the global bank note program as of March 31, 2014.

Liquidity Coverage Ratio and Net Stable Funding Ratio

The BCBS’ key reform within the Basel III framework to strengthen international liquidity standards was the introduction of the LCR and NSFR. On January 7, 2013, the BCBS issued a final standard for the LCR applicable to large internationally active banking organizations. The BCBS plans on introducing the NSFR final standard in the next two years.

The BCBS’ LCR would promote the short-term resilience of a bank’s liquidity profile by ensuring an adequate level of unencumbered high-quality liquid assets that can be converted into cash easily and immediately in private markets to meet its liquidity needs within 30 calendar days. Financial institutions subject to the LCR generally would be expected to hold unencumbered high-quality assets of at least 100% of net cash flows over the next 30 calendar days upon full implementation in 2019.

The BCBS’ NSFR is intended to promote medium and long-term funding of the assets and activities of financial institutions. This ratio would establish a minimum acceptable amount of stable funding based on the liquidity characteristics of a financial institution’s assets and activities over a one year horizon. Management is currently monitoring the progress of the BCBS’ work on the NSFR.

Section 165 of the Dodd-Frank Act requires the FRB to establish enhanced liquidity standards for BHCs with total assets of $50 billion or greater. On October 24, 2013, the U.S. Banking Agencies issued a NPR that would implement a LCR requirement that is generally consistent with the international LCR standards published by the BCBS for large internationally active banking organizations, generally those with $250 billion or more in total consolidated assets or $10 billion or more in on-balance sheet foreign exposure. Additionally, a Modified LCR requirement was proposed for BHC’s with total consolidated assets of at least $50 billion that are not large internationally active banking organizations, like Fifth Third. The Modified LCR requirement incorporates a shorter (21-calendar days) stress scenario for calculating total net cash outflows than the LCR’s 30 calendar day requirement. Therefore, the estimated net cash outflows for the Modified LCR generally would be 70% of the LCR’s estimated net cash outflows. The NPR’s transition period will begin on January 1, 2015 whereby LCR and Modified LCR entities must comply with a minimum ratio of 80%. On January 1, 2016 and 2017, the minimum ratio would increase to 90% and 100%, respectively. The NPR was open for public comment until January 31, 2014. Management is currently reviewing the NPR and evaluating its impact upon the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

Credit Ratings

The cost and availability of financing to the Bancorp are impacted by its credit ratings. A downgrade to the Bancorp’s credit ratings could affect its ability to access the credit markets and increase its borrowing costs, thereby adversely impacting the Bancorp’s financial condition and liquidity. Key factors in maintaining high credit ratings include a stable and diverse earnings stream, strong credit quality, strong capital ratios and diverse funding sources, in addition to disciplined liquidity monitoring procedures.

The Bancorp’s credit ratings are summarized in Table 54. The ratings reflect the ratings agencies view on the Bancorp’s capacity to meet financial commitments. *

* As an investor, you should be aware that a security rating is not a recommendation to buy, sell or hold securities, that it may be subject to revision or withdrawal at any time by the assigning rating organization and that each rating should be evaluated independently of any other rating. Additional information on the credit rating ranking within the overall classification system is located on the website of each credit rating agency.

TABLE 54: Agency Ratings

 

As of May 8, 2014

   Moody’s    Standard and Poor’s    Fitch    DBRS

Fifth Third Bancorp:

           

Short-term

   No rating    A-2    F1    R-1L

Senior debt

   Baa1    BBB+    A    AL

Subordinated debt

   Baa2    BBB    A-    BBBH

Fifth Third Bank:

           

Short-term

   P-2    A-2    F1    R-1L

Long-term deposit

   A3    No rating    A+    A

Senior debt

   A3    A-    A    A

Subordinated debt

   Baa1    BBB+    A-    AL
  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

CAPITAL MANAGEMENT

Management regularly reviews the Bancorp’s capital levels to help ensure it is appropriately positioned under various operating environments. The Bancorp has established a Capital Committee which is responsible for making capital plan recommendations to management. These recommendations are reviewed by the ERM Committee and the capital plan is approved by the board. The Capital Committee is responsible for execution oversight of the capital actions of the capital plan.

 

49


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

Capital Ratios

The U.S banking agencies established quantitative measures that assign risk weightings to assets and off-balance sheet items and also define and set minimum regulatory capital requirements. The U.S. banking agencies define “well capitalized” ratios for Tier I and total risk-based capital as 6% and 10%, respectively. The Bancorp exceeded these “well-capitalized” ratios for all periods presented.

The Basel II advanced approach framework was finalized by U.S. banking agencies in 2007. Core banks, defined as those with consolidated total assets in excess of $250 billion or on-balance sheet foreign exposures of $10 billion were required to adopt the advanced approach effective April 1, 2008. The Bancorp does not meet these thresholds and, therefore, is not subject to the requirements of Basel II.

The Dodd-Frank Act requires more stringent prudential standards, including capital and liquidity requirements, for larger institutions. It also addresses the quality of capital components by limiting the degree to which certain hybrid instruments can be included. The Dodd-Frank Act will phase out the inclusion of certain TruPS as a component of Tier I risk-based capital when the Bancorp implements the revised regulatory capital rules known as Basel III.

In December of 2010 and revised in June of 2011, the BCBS issued Basel III, a global regulatory framework, to enhance international capital standards. In June of 2012, U.S. banking regulators proposed enhancements to the regulatory capital requirements for U.S. banks, which implement aspects of Basel III, such as re-defining the regulatory capital elements and minimum capital ratios, introducing regulatory capital buffers above those minimums, revising the agencies’ rules for calculating risk-weighted assets and introducing a new Tier I common equity ratio. In July of 2013, U.S. banking regulators approved final enhanced regulatory capital requirements (Basel III Final Rule), which included modifications to the proposed rules. The Basel III Final Rule provided for certain banks, including the Bancorp, to opt out of including AOCI in Tier 1 capital and also retained the treatment of residential mortgage exposures consistent with the current Basel I capital rules. The Basel III Final Rule will phase out the inclusion of certain TruPS as a component of Tier I capital. Under these provisions, these TruPS would qualify as a component of Tier II capital. At March 31, 2014, the Bancorp’s Tier I capital included $60 million of TruPS representing approximately 5 bps of risk weighted assets. The Basel III Final Rule is effective for the Bancorp on January 1, 2015, subject to phase-in periods for certain of its components and other provisions. The Bancorp is in the process of evaluating the Basel III Final Rule and its potential impact. The Bancorp’s current estimate of the pro-forma fully phased in Tier I common equity ratio at March 31, 2014 under the Basel III Final Rule is approximately 9.12% compared with 9.51% as calculated under the existing Basel I capital framework. The primary drivers of the change from the existing Basel I capital framework to the Basel III Final Rule are an increase in Tier I common equity of approximately 89 bps (primarily from the elimination of the current 10% deduction of mortgage servicing rights from capital), which would be more than offset by the impact of increases in risk-weighted assets (primarily from the treatment of securitization exposures, mortgage servicing rights and commitments with an original maturity of one year or less). If the Bancorp were to elect to include AOCI components in capital, the March 31, 2014 pro forma Basel III Final Rule Tier 1 common ratio would be increased by approximately 16 bps. The pro-forma Tier I common equity ratio exceeds the proposed minimum Tier I common equity ratio of 7% comprised of a minimum ratio of 4.5% plus a capital conservation buffer of 2.5%. The pro-forma Tier I common equity ratio does not include the effect of any mitigating actions the Bancorp may undertake to offset the impact of the proposed capital enhancements. Additionally, pursuant to the Basel III Final Rule, the minimum capital ratios as of January 1, 2015 will be 6% for the Tier I capital ratio, 8% for the total risk-based capital ratio and 4% for the Tier I capital to average consolidated assets (leverage ratio). For further discussion on the Basel I and Basel III Tier I common equity ratios, see the Non-GAAP Financial Measures section of MD&A.

TABLE 55: Capital Ratios

 

($ in millions)

   March 31, 2014     December 31, 2013  

Average equity as a percent of average assets

     11.53      11.51  

Tangible equity as a percent of tangible assets(a)

     9.61       9.44  

Tangible common equity as a percent of tangible assets(a)

     8.79       8.63  

Tier I capital

   $ 12,182       12,094  

Total risk-based capital

     16,356       16,441  

Risk-weighted assets(b)

     116,622       116,736  

Regulatory capital ratios:

    

Tier I risk-based capital

     10.45      10.36  

Total risk-based capital

     14.02       14.08  

Tier I leverage

     9.65       9.64  

Tier I common equity(a)

     9.51       9.39  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) For further information on these ratios, see the Non-GAAP Financial Measures section of MD&A.
(b) Under the banking agencies’ risk-based capital guidelines, assets and credit equivalent amounts of derivatives and off-balance sheet exposures are assigned to broad risk categories. The aggregate dollar amount in each risk category is multiplied by the associated risk weight of the category. The resulting weighted values are added together resulting in the Bancorp’s total risk-weighted assets.

Stress Tests and CCAR

In 2011 the FRB adopted the capital plan rule, which requires BHCs with consolidated assets of $50 billion or more to submit annual capital plans to the FRB for review. Under the rule, these capital plans must included detailed descriptions of the following: the BHC’s internal processes for assessing capital adequacy; the policies governing capital actions such as common stock issuances, dividends, and share repurchases; and all planned capital actions over a nine-quarter planning horizon. Further, each BHC must also report to the FRB the results of stress tests conducted by the BHC under a number of scenarios that assess the sources and uses of capital under baseline and stressed economic scenarios. The FRB launched the 2014 stress testing program and CCAR on November 1, 2013, with firm submissions of stress test results and capital plans to the FRB due on January 6, 2014, which the Bancorp submitted as required.

 

50


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

The FRB’s review of the capital plan assessed the comprehensiveness of the capital plan, the reasonableness of the assumptions and the analysis underlying the capital plan. Additionally, the FRB reviewed the robustness of the capital adequacy process, the capital policy and the Bancorp’s ability to maintain capital above the minimum regulatory capital ratios and above a Tier I common ratio of five percent on a pro forma basis under expected and stressful conditions throughout the planning horizon. The FRB assessed the Bancorp’s strategies for addressing proposed revisions to the regulatory capital framework agreed upon by the BCBS and requirements arising from the Dodd-Frank Act.

On March 26, 2014 the FRB announced it had completed the 2014 CCAR. For BHCs that proposed capital distributions in their plans, the FRB either objected to the plan or provided a non-objection whereby the FRB permitted the proposed 2014 capital distributions. The FRB indicated to the Bancorp that it did not object to the following proposed capital actions for the period beginning April 1, 2014 and ending March 31, 2015:

 

   

The potential increase in the quarterly common stock dividend to $0.13 per share;

   

The potential repurchase of common shares in an amount up to $669 million; and

   

The additional ability to repurchase shares in the amount of any after-tax gains from the sale of Vantiv, Inc. common stock.

The above potential capital actions are subject to Board approval and other factors including regulatory developments and market conditions.

Additionally, as a CCAR institution, the Bancorp is required to disclose the results of its company-run stress test under the supervisory severely adverse scenario, and to provide information related to the types of risk included in its stress testing; a general description of the methodologies used; estimates of certain financial results and pro forma capital ratios; and an explanation of the most significant causes of changes in regulatory capital ratios. On March 26, 2014 the Bancorp publicly disclosed the results of its company-run stress test as required by the Dodd-Frank Act stress testing rules, in a Form 8-K.

The BHCs that participated in the 2014 CCAR, including the Bancorp, are required to conduct mid-cycle company-run stress tests using data as of March 31, 2014. The stress tests must be based on three BHC defined scenarios – baseline, adverse and severely adverse. The BHCs must report the mid-cycle stress test results to the FRB by July 7, 2014. In addition, between September 15 and September 30, 2014, the BHCs must publicly disclose a summary of the results under the severely adverse scenario.

Dividend Policy and Stock Repurchase Program

The Bancorp’s common stock dividend policy and stock repurchase program reflect its earnings outlook, desired payout ratios, the need to maintain adequate capital levels, the ability of its subsidiaries to pay dividends, the need to comply with safe and sound banking practices as well as meet regulatory requirements and expectations. The Bancorp declared dividends per common share of $0.12 and $0.11 for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Bancorp entered into a number of accelerated share repurchase transactions during 2013 and the three months ended March 31, 2014. Refer to Note 13 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information on the accelerated share repurchases.

TABLE 56: Share Repurchases

 

Period

   Total Number of
Shares
Purchased
(a)
    Average
Price Paid
Per Share
     Total Number of Shares
Purchased as Part of
Publicly Announced Plans
or Programs
     Maximum Number of Shares
that May Yet be Purchased
Under the Plans or Programs
 

January 1, 2014 - January 31, 2014

     3,950,705      $ 21.74        3,950,705        39,120,908  

February 1, 2014 - February 28, 2014

     —          —          —          39,120,908  

March 1, 2014 - March 31, 2014(c)

     4,029,536 (b)      21.21        4,029,536        100,000,000  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     7,980,241      $ 21.47        7,980,241        100,000,000  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) The Bancorp repurchased 411,355 shares during the first quarter of 2014 in connection with various employee compensation plans. These purchases are not included in the calculation for average price paid per share and do not count against the maximum number of shares that may yet be purchased under the Board of Directors’ authorization.
(b) Shares received from the counterparty as final settlement of the Repurchase Agreements.
(c) In March of 2014, the Bancorp announced that its Board of Directors had authorized management to purchase 100 million shares of the Bancorp’s common stock through the open market or in any private party transactions. The authorization does not include specific price targets or an expiration date. All shares settled during the first quarter of 2014 were included under the previous 100 million share repurchase program.

 

51


Table of Contents

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (continued)

 

 

OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS

In the ordinary course of business, the Bancorp enters into financial transactions that are considered off-balance sheet arrangements as they involve varying elements of market, credit and liquidity risk in excess of the amounts recognized in the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. The Bancorp’s off-balance sheet arrangements include commitments, contingent liabilities, guarantees, and transactions with non-consolidated VIEs. A brief discussion of these transactions is as follows:

Commitments

The Bancorp has certain commitments to make future payments under contracts, including commitments to extend credit, letters of credit, forward contracts related to held for sale mortgage loans, noncancelable lease obligations, capital commitments for private equity investments and purchase obligations. Refer to Note 14 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information on commitments.

Guarantees and Contingent Liabilities

The Bancorp has performance obligations upon the occurrence of certain events provided in certain contractual arrangements, including residential mortgage loans sold with representation and warranty provisions or credit recourse. Refer to Note 14 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information on guarantees and contingent liabilities.

Transactions with Non-consolidated VIEs

The Bancorp engages in a variety of activities that involve VIEs, which are legal entities that lack sufficient equity to finance their activities, or the equity investors of the entities as a group lack any of the characteristics of a controlling interest. The investments in those entities in which the Bancorp was determined not to be the primary beneficiary but holds a variable interest in the entity are accounted for under the equity method of accounting or other accounting standards as appropriate and not consolidated. Refer to Note 8 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information on non-consolidated VIEs.

 

52


Table of Contents

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure about Market Risk (Item 3)

 

Information presented in the Market Risk Management section of Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations is incorporated herein by reference.

Controls and Procedures (Item 4)

 

The Bancorp conducted an evaluation, under the supervision and with the participation of the Bancorp’s management, including the Bancorp’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of the design and operation of the Bancorp’s disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act). Based on the foregoing, as of the end of the period covered by this report, the Bancorp’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that the Bancorp’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective, in all material respects, to ensure that information required to be disclosed in the reports the Bancorp files and submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported as and when required and information is accumulated and communicated to the Bancorp’s management, including its Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure. The Bancorp’s management also conducted an evaluation of internal control over financial reporting to determine whether any changes occurred during the period covered by this report that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Bancorp’s internal control over financial reporting. Based on this evaluation, there has been no such change during the period covered by this report.

 

53


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes (Item 1)

 

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS (unaudited)

 

     As of  

($ in millions, except share data)

   March 31,
2014
    December 31,
2013
 

Assets

    

Cash and due from banks(a)

   $ 3,153       3,178  

Available-for-sale and other securities(b)

     20,749       18,597  

Held-to-maturity securities(c)

     195       208  

Trading securities

     347       343  

Other short-term investments(a)

     2,202       5,116  

Loans held for sale(d)

     780       944  

Portfolio loans and leases:

    

Commercial and industrial loans

     40,591       39,316  

Commercial mortgage loans(a)

     7,958       8,066  

Commercial construction loans

     1,218       1,039  

Commercial leases

     3,577       3,625  

Residential mortgage loans(e)

     12,626       12,680  

Home equity

     9,125       9,246  

Automobile loans(a)

     12,088       11,984  

Credit card

     2,177       2,294  

Other consumer loans and leases

     345       364  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Portfolio loans and leases

     89,705       88,614  

Allowance for loan and lease losses(a)

     (1,483     (1,582
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Portfolio loans and leases, net

     88,222       87,032  

Bank premises and equipment

     2,528       2,531  

Operating lease equipment

     714       730  

Goodwill

     2,416       2,416  

Intangible assets

     18       19  

Servicing rights

     975       971  

Other assets(a)

     7,355       8,358  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Assets

   $ 129,654       130,443  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities

    

Deposits:

    

Demand

   $ 31,234       32,634  

Interest checking

     25,472       25,875  

Savings

     16,867       17,045  

Money market

     13,208       11,644  

Other time

     3,660       3,530  

Certificates - $100,000 and over

     4,511       6,571  

Foreign office and other

     1,922       1,976  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deposits

     96,874       99,275  

Federal funds purchased

     268       284  

Other short-term borrowings

     2,717       1,380  

Accrued taxes, interest and expenses

     1,669       1,758  

Other liabilities(a)

     2,029       3,487  

Long-term debt(a)

     11,233       9,633  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Liabilities

     114,790       115,817  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Equity

    

Common stock(f)

     2,051       2,051  

Preferred stock(g)

     1,034       1,034  

Capital surplus

     2,674       2,561  

Retained earnings

     10,363       10,156  

Accumulated other comprehensive income

     196       82  

Treasury stock(f)

     (1,492     (1,295
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Bancorp shareholders’ equity

     14,826       14,589  

Noncontrolling interests

     38       37  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Equity

     14,864       14,626  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Liabilities and Equity

   $ 129,654       130,443  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Includes $102 and $49 of cash and due from banks, $7 and $0 of other short-term investments, $48 and $48 of commercial mortgage loans, $2,031 and $1,010 of automobile loans, $(18) and $(15) of ALLL, $23 and $13 of other assets, $3 and $1 of other liabilities, and $2,119 and $1,048 of long-term debt from consolidated VIEs that are included in their respective captions above at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. See Note 8.
(b) Amortized cost of $20,393 and $18,409 at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.
(c) Fair value of $195 and $208 at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.
(d) Includes $649 and $890 of residential mortgage loans held for sale measured at fair value at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.
(e) Includes $103 and $92 of residential mortgage loans measured at fair value at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.
(f) Common shares: Stated value $2.22 per share; authorized 2,000,000,000; outstanding at March 31, 2014 – 847,568,728 (excludes 76,323,853 treasury shares), December 31, 2013 – 855,305,745 (excludes 68,586,836 treasury shares).
(g) 458,000 shares of undesignated no par value preferred stock are authorized and unissued at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013; fixed-to-floating rate non-cumulative Series H perpetual preferred stock with a $25,000 liquidation preference: 24,000 authorized shares, issued and outstanding at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013 and fixed-to-floating rate non-cumulative Series I perpetual preferred stock with a $25,000 liquidation preference; 18,000 authorized shares, issued and outstanding at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

54


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes (continued)

 

 

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME (unaudited)

 

 

      For the three months ended
March 31,
 

($ in millions, except share data)

   2014      2013  

Interest Income

     

Interest and fees on loans and leases

   $ 823        882  

Interest on securities

     168        112  

Interest on other short-term investments

     2        1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total interest income

     993        995  

Interest Expense

     

Interest on deposits

     48        50  

Interest on other short-term borrowings

     1        3  

Interest on long-term debt

     51        54  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total interest expense

     100        107  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net Interest Income

     893        888  

Provision for loan and lease losses

     69        62  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net Interest Income After Provision for Loan and Lease Losses

     824        826  

Noninterest Income

     

Service charges on deposits

     133        131  

Mortgage banking net revenue

     109        220  

Corporate banking revenue

     104        99  

Investment advisory revenue

     102        100  

Card and processing revenue

     68        65  

Other noninterest income

     41        109  

Securities gains, net

     7        17  

Securities gains, net - non-qualifying hedges on mortgage servicing rights

     —          2  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total noninterest income

     564        743  

Noninterest Expense

     

Salaries, wages and incentives

     359        399  

Employee benefits

     101        114  

Net occupancy expense

     80        79  

Technology and communications

     53        49  

Card and processing expense

     31        31  

Equipment expense

     30        28  

Other noninterest expense

     296        278  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total noninterest expense

     950        978  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income Before Income Taxes

     438        591  

Applicable income tax expense

     119        179  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net Income

     319        412  

Less: Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests

     1        (10
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net Income Attributable to Bancorp

     318        422  

Dividends on preferred stock

     9        9  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net Income Available to Common Shareholders

   $ 309        413  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Earnings Per Share

   $ 0.36        0.47  

Earnings Per Diluted Share

   $ 0.36        0.46  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Average common shares - basic

     845,860,065        870,923,074  

Average common shares - diluted

     857,923,596        913,163,262  

Cash dividends declared per common share

   $ 0.12        0.11  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

55


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes (continued)

 

 

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (unaudited)

 

 

      For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Net income

   $ 319       412  

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:

    

Unrealized gains on available-for-sale securities:

    

Unrealized holding gains (losses) on available-for-sale securities arising during period

     113       (36

Reclassification adjustment for net (gains) losses included in net income

     (3     5  

Unrealized gains on cash flow hedge derivatives:

    

Unrealized holding gains on cash flow hedge derivatives arising during period

     10       1  

Reclassification adjustment for net gains included in net income

     (7     (14

Defined benefit pension plans:

    

Reclassification of amounts to net periodic benefit costs

     1       2  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss)

     114       (42

Comprehensive income

     433       370  

Less: Comprehensive income attributable to noncontrolling interests

     1       (10
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income attributable to Bancorp

   $ 432       380  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

56


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes (continued)

 

 

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN EQUITY (unaudited)

 

 

     Bancorp Shareholders’ Equity              

($ in millions, except per share data)

  Common
Stock
    Preferred
Stock
    Capital
Surplus
    Retained
Earnings
    Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive

Income
    Treasury
Stock
    Total
Bancorp
Shareholders’
Equity
    Non-
Controlling
Interests
    Total
Equity
 

Balance at December 31, 2012

  $ 2,051       398       2,758       8,768       375       (634     13,716       48       13,764  

Net income

          422           422       (10     412  

Other comprehensive loss

            (42       (42       (42

Cash dividends declared:

                 

Common stock at $0.11 per share

          (96         (96       (96

Preferred stock

          (9         (9       (9

Shares acquired for treasury

        10           (135     (125       (125

Impact of stock transactions under stock compensation plans, net

        14           3       17         17  

Other

          (1         (1       (1
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at March 31, 2013

    2,051       398       2,782       9,084       333       (766     13,882       38       13,920  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2013

    2,051       1,034       2,561       10,156       82       (1,295     14,589       37       14,626  

Net income

          318           318       1       319  

Other comprehensive income

            114         114         114  

Cash dividends declared:

                 

Common stock at $0.12 per share

          (102         (102       (102

Preferred stock

          (9         (9       (9

Shares acquired for treasury

        100           (199     (99       (99

Impact of stock transactions under stock compensation plans, net

        13           2       15         15  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at March 31, 2014

  $ 2,051       1,034       2,674       10,363       196       (1,492     14,826       38       14,864  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

57


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes (continued)

 

 

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS (unaudited)

 

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Operating Activities

    

Net income

   $ 319       412  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

    

Provision for loan and lease losses

     69       62  

Depreciation, amortization and accretion

     98       137  

Stock-based compensation expense

     17       17  

Provision for deferred income taxes

     37       37  

Securities gains, net

     (7     (17

Securities gains, net – non-qualifying hedges on mortgage servicing rights

     —         (2

Recovery of MSR impairment

     (4     (49

Net gains on sales of loans and fair value adjustments on loans held for sale

     (3     (141

Capitalized servicing rights

     (23     (79

Proceeds from sales of loans held for sale

     1,674       7,097  

Loans originated for sale, net of repayments

     (1,419     (6,078

Dividends representing return on equity method investments

     1       4  

Net change in:

    

Trading securities

     (4     (9

Other assets

     432       (533

Accrued taxes, interest and expenses

     (185     (120

Other liabilities

     (662     487  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities

     340       1,225  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investing Activities

    

Sales:

    

Available-for-sale securities

     2,069       2,215  

Loans

     36       552  

Disposal of bank premises and equipment

     2       3  

Repayments / maturities:

    

Available-for-sale securities

     561       910  

Held-to-maturity securities

     13       —    

Purchases:

    

Available-for-sale securities

     (4,806     (2,906

Bank premises and equipment

     (61     (61

Proceeds from sales and dividends representing return of equity method investments

     29       74  

Net change in:

    

Other short-term investments

     2,914       135  

Loans and leases

     (1,388     (1,208

Operating lease equipment

     (1     (30
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Used in Investing Activities

     (632     (316
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing Activities

    

Net change in:

    

Core deposits

     (340     (2

Certificates - $100,000 and over, including other foreign office

     (2,061     2,109  

Federal funds purchased

     (15     (515

Other short-term borrowings

     1,337       (3,841

Dividends paid on common shares

     (103     (88

Dividends paid on preferred shares

     (9     —    

Proceeds from issuance of long-term debt

     1,745       1,300  

Repayment of long-term debt

     (186     (2

Repurchase of treasury shares and related forward contract

     (99     (125

Other

     (2     —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Provided by (Used in) Financing Activities

     267       (1,164
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Decrease in Cash and Due from Banks

     (25     (255

Cash and Due from Banks at Beginning of Period

     3,178       2,441  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and Due from Banks at End of Period

   $ 3,153       2,186  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements. Note 2 contains cash payments related to interest and income taxes in addition to noncash investing and financing activities.

 

58


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

1. Basis of Presentation

The Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements include the accounts of the Bancorp and its majority-owned subsidiaries and VIEs in which the Bancorp has been determined to be the primary beneficiary. Other entities, including certain joint ventures, in which the Bancorp has the ability to exercise significant influence over operating and financial policies of the investee, but upon which the Bancorp does not possess control, are accounted for by the equity method and not consolidated. Those entities in which the Bancorp does not have the ability to exercise significant influence are generally carried at the lower of cost or fair value. Intercompany transactions and balances have been eliminated.

In the opinion of management, the unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements include all adjustments, which consist of normal recurring accruals, necessary to present fairly the results for the periods presented. In accordance with U.S. GAAP and the rules and regulations of the SEC for interim financial information, these statements do not include certain information and footnote disclosures required for complete annual financial statements and it is suggested that these Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements be read in conjunction with the latest annual financial statements. The results of operations and comprehensive income for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013 and the cash flows and changes in equity for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013 are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for the full year. Financial information as of December 31, 2013 has been derived from the annual audited Consolidated Financial Statements of the Bancorp.

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and accompanying notes. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

2. Supplemental Cash Flow Information

Cash payments related to interest and income taxes in addition to noncash investing and financing activities are presented in the following table for the three months ended March 31:

 

($ in millions)

   2014      2013  

Cash payments:

     

Interest

   $ 133        122  

Income taxes

     21        34  

Transfers:

     

Portfolio loans to loans held for sale

     73        590  

Loans held for sale to portfolio loans

     12        12  

Portfolio loans to OREO

     37        64  

Loans held for sale to OREO

     2        3  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

3. Accounting and Reporting Developments

Obligations Resulting from Joint and Several Liability Arrangements for Which the Total Amount of the Obligation is Fixed at the Reporting Date

In February 2013, the FASB issued amended guidance relating to the measurement of obligations resulting from joint and several liability arrangements for which the total amount under the arrangement is fixed at the reporting date. For the total amount of an obligation under an arrangement to be considered fixed at the reporting date, there can be no measurement uncertainty relating to the total amount of the obligation. The obligation resulting from joint and several liability arrangements is measured initially as the sum of 1) the amount the Bancorp has agreed to pay on the basis of its arrangement among its co-obligors and 2) any additional amount the Bancorp expects to pay on behalf of its co-obligors. The amended guidance also requires the Bancorp to disclose the nature and amount of the obligation as well as information about the risks that such obligations pose to future cash flows. The amended guidance was effective for reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2013 and is applied retrospectively to all prior periods presented for those obligations resulting from joint and several liability arrangements that exist at the beginning of the fiscal year of adoption. The Bancorp adopted the amended guidance on January 1, 2014 and the adoption did not have a material impact on the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

Presentation of an Unrecognized Tax Benefit When a Net Operating Loss Carryforward, a Similar Tax Loss, or a Tax Credit Carryforward Exists

In July 2013, the FASB issued amended guidance to clarify that an unrecognized tax benefit, or a portion of an unrecognized tax benefit, should be presented in the financial statements as a reduction to a deferred tax asset for a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss, or a tax credit carryforward, except as follows. To the extent a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss, or a tax credit carryforward is not available at the reporting date under the tax law of the applicable jurisdiction to settle any income taxes that would result from the disallowance of a tax position or the tax law of the applicable jurisdiction does not require the entity to use, and the entity does not intend to use, the deferred tax asset for such purpose, the unrecognized tax benefit should be presented in the financial statements as a liability and should not be combined with deferred tax assets. The assessment of whether a deferred tax asset is available is based on the unrecognized tax benefit and deferred tax asset that exist at the reporting date and should be made presuming disallowance of the tax position at the reporting date. The amended guidance was effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2013, with early adoption permitted. The Bancorp adopted the amended guidance on January 1, 2014 and the adoption of the amended guidance did not have a material impact on the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

59


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

Accounting for Investments in Qualified Affordable Housing Projects

In January 2014, the FASB issued amended guidance that permits the Bancorp to make an accounting policy election to account for its investments in qualified affordable housing projects using a proportional amortization method if certain conditions are met. Under the proportional amortization method, the Bancorp would amortize the initial cost of the investment in proportion to the tax credits and other tax benefits received and recognize the net investment performance in the income statement as a component of income tax expense (benefit). The amended guidance requires disclosure of the nature of the Bancorp’s investments in qualified affordable housing projects, and the effect of the measurement of the investments in qualified affordable housing projects and the related tax credits on the Bancorp’s financial position and results of operation. The amended guidance is effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2014, with early adoption permitted. The Bancorp is currently in the process of evaluating whether it will make a policy election to account for its investments in qualified affordable housing projects using the proportional amortization method if applicable, and if this policy election is made, whether to early adopt the amended guidance.

Reclassification of Residential Real Estate Collateralized Consumer Mortgage Loans upon Foreclosure

In January 2014, the FASB issued amended guidance that clarifies when a creditor should be considered to have received physical possession of residential real estate property collateralizing a consumer mortgage loan such that the loan receivable should be derecognized and the real estate property recognized. The amended guidance clarifies that an in substance repossession or foreclosure occurs, and a creditor is considered to have received physical possession of residential real estate property collateralizing a consumer mortgage loan, upon either (1) the creditor obtaining legal title to the residential real estate property upon completion of a foreclosure or (2) the borrower conveying all interest in the residential real estate property to the creditor to satisfy that loan through completion of a deed in lieu of foreclosure or through a similar legal agreement. In addition, the amended guidance requires interim and annual disclosures of both (1) the amount of foreclosed residential real estate property held by the creditor and (2) the recorded investment in consumer mortgage loans collateralized by residential real estate property that are in the process of foreclosure according to local requirements of the applicable jurisdiction. The amended guidance may be applied prospectively or through a modified retrospective approach and is effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2014, with early adoption permitted. The adoption of the amended guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

Reporting Discontinued Operations and Disclosures of Disposals of Components of an Entity

In April 2014, the FASB issued amended guidance that changes the criteria for reporting discontinued operations. The amended guidance requires a disposal of a component of an entity or a group of components of an entity to be reported in discontinued operations if the disposal represents a strategic shift that has (or will have) a major effect on an entity’s operations and financial results when any of the following occurs: 1) the component of an entity or group of components of an entity meets the criteria to be classified as held for sale; 2) The component of an entity or group of components of an entity is disposed of by sale; or 3) The component of an entity or group of components of an entity is disposed of other than by sale (for example, by abandonment or in a distribution to owners in a spinoff). The amended guidance requires an entity to present, for each comparative period, the assets and liabilities of a disposal group that includes a discontinued operation separately in the asset and liability sections, respectively, of the statement of financial position, as well as additional disclosures about discontinued operations. The amended guidance is to be applied prospectively for 1) all disposals (or classifications as held for sale) of components of an entity that occur within annual periods beginning on or after December 15, 2014, and interim periods within those years; and 2) all businesses or nonprofit activities that, on acquisition, are classified as held for sale that occur within annual periods beginning on or after December 15, 2014, and interim periods within those years. Early adoption is permitted, but only for disposals (or classifications as held for sale) that have not been reported in financial statements previously issued. The adoption of the amended guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

4. Securities

The following table provides the amortized cost, fair value and unrealized gains and losses for the major categories of the available-for-sale and other and held-to-maturity securities portfolios as of:

 

March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

   Amortized
Cost
     Unrealized
Gains
     Unrealized
Losses
    Fair
Value
 

Available-for-sale and other:

          

U.S. Treasury and government agencies

   $ 26        —          —         26  

U.S. Government sponsored agencies

     1,522        113        —         1,635  

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

     186        8        —         194  

Agency mortgage-backed securities(a)

     14,029        220        (64     14,185  

Other bonds, notes and debentures

     3,917        81        (7     3,991  

Other securities(b)

     713        6        (1     718  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 20,393        428        (72     20,749  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Held-to-maturity:

          

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

   $ 194        —          —         194  

Other debt securities

     1        —          —         1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 195        —          —         195  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

60


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

December 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

   Amortized
Cost
     Unrealized
Gains
     Unrealized
Losses
    Fair
Value
 

Available-for-sale and other:

          

U.S. Treasury and government agencies

   $ 26        —          —         26  

U.S. Government sponsored agencies

     1,523        121        —         1,644  

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

     187        5        —         192  

Agency mortgage-backed securities(a)

     12,294        140        (150     12,284  

Other bonds, notes and debentures

     3,514        76        (8     3,582  

Other securities(b)

     865        5        (1     869  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 18,409        347        (159     18,597  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Held-to-maturity:

          

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

   $ 207        —          —         207  

Other debt securities

     1        —          —         1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 208        —          —         208  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Includes interest-only mortgage backed securities of $217 and $262 as of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, recorded at fair value with fair value changes recorded in securities gains, net and securities gains, net-non-qualifying hedges on mortgage servicing rights in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income.
(b) Other securities consist of FHLB and FRB restricted stock holdings of $249 and $350, respectively, at March 31, 2014 and $402 and $349, respectively, at December 31, 2013, that are carried at cost, and certain mutual fund and equity security holdings.

The following table presents realized gains and losses that were recognized in income from available-for-sale securities:

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Realized gains

   $ 27       18  

Realized losses

     (5     (25

OTTI

     (17     —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net realized gains (losses)(a)

   $ 5       (7
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Excludes net gains on interest-only mortgage-backed securities of $1 and $24 for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

Trading securities totaled $347 million as of March 31, 2014, compared to $343 million at December 31, 2013. Gross realized gains and gross realized losses on trading securities were immaterial to the Bancorp for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013. Net unrealized gains on trading securities were $1 million and $2 million at March 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

At March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, securities with a fair value of $10.6 billion and $11.6 billion, respectively, were pledged to secure borrowings, public deposits, trust funds, derivative contracts and for other purposes as required or permitted by law.

The expected maturity distribution of the Bancorp’s agency mortgage-backed securities and the contractual maturity distribution of the remainder of the Bancorp’s available-for-sale and other and held-to-maturity securities as of March 31, 2014 are shown in the following table:

 

     Available-for-Sale & Other      Held-to-Maturity  

($ in millions)

   Amortized Cost      Fair Value      Amortized Cost      Fair Value  

Debt securities:(a)

           

Under 1 year

   $ 92        95        16        16  

1-5 years

     3,626        3,814        160        160  

5-10 years

     12,430        12,507        17        17  

Over 10 years

     3,532        3,615        2        2  

Other securities

     713        718        —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 20,393        20,749        195        195  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Actual maturities may differ from contractual maturities when there exists a right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.

 

61


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

The following table provides the fair value and gross unrealized losses on available-for-sale and other securities in an unrealized loss position, aggregated by investment category and length of time the individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position as of:

 

     Less than 12 months     12 months or more     Total  

($ in millions)

   Fair Value      Unrealized Losses     Fair Value      Unrealized Losses     Fair Value      Unrealized Losses  

March 31, 2014

               

Agency mortgage-backed securities

     5,323        (64     —          —         5,323        (64

Other bonds, notes and debentures

     942        (5     156        (2     1,098        (7

Other securities

     33        (1     4        —         37        (1
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 6,298        (70     160        (2     6,458        (72
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

December 31, 2013

               

Agency mortgage-backed securities

   $ 7,221        (150     1        —         7,222        (150

Other bonds, notes and debentures

     595        (5     132        (3     727        (8

Other securities

     33        (1     4        —         37        (1
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 7,849        (156     137        (3     7,986        (159
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other-Than-Temporary Impairments

The Bancorp recognized $17 million of OTTI, included in securities gains, net, in the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income, on its available-for sale and other debt securities during the three months ended March 31, 2014 and did not recognize any OTTI on its available-for sale and other debt securities during the three months ended March 31, 2013. The Bancorp did not recognize OTTI on any of its available-for-sale equity securities or its held-to-maturity debt securities during the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013. Less than one percent of unrealized losses in the available-for-sale securities portfolio were represented by non-rated securities at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

 

62


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

5. Loans and Leases

The Bancorp diversifies its loan and lease portfolio by offering a variety of loan and lease products with various payment terms and rate structures. Lending activities are concentrated within those states in which the Bancorp has banking centers and are primarily located in the Midwestern and Southeastern regions of the United States. The Bancorp’s commercial loan portfolio consists of lending to various industry types. Management periodically reviews the performance of its loan and lease products to evaluate whether they are performing within acceptable interest rate and credit risk levels and changes are made to underwriting policies and procedures as needed. The Bancorp maintains an allowance to absorb loan and lease losses inherent in the portfolio. For further information on credit quality and the ALLL, see Note 6.

The following table provides a summary of the total loans and leases classified by primary purpose as of:

 

     March 31,      December 31,  

($ in millions)

   2014      2013  

Loans and leases held for sale:

     

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 101        31  

Commercial mortgage loans

     1        3  

Commercial construction loans

     2        2  

Commercial leases

     —          1  

Residential mortgage loans

     649        890  

Other consumer loans and leases

     27        17  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total loans and leases held for sale

   $ 780        944  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Portfolio loans and leases:

     

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 40,591        39,316  

Commercial mortgage loans

     7,958        8,066  

Commercial construction loans

     1,218        1,039  

Commercial leases

     3,577        3,625  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total commercial loans and leases

     53,344        52,046  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Residential mortgage loans

     12,626        12,680  

Home equity

     9,125        9,246  

Automobile loans

     12,088        11,984  

Credit card

     2,177        2,294  

Other consumer loans and leases

     345        364  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total consumer loans and leases

     36,361        36,568  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total portfolio loans and leases

   $ 89,705        88,614  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total portfolio loans and leases are recorded net of unearned income, which totaled $680 million as of March 31, 2014 and $700 million as of December 31, 2013. Additionally, portfolio loans and leases are recorded net of unamortized premiums and discounts, deferred loan fees and costs, and fair value adjustments (associated with acquired loans or loans designated at fair value upon origination) which totaled a net premium of $125 million and $111 million as of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.

The Bancorp’s FHLB and FRB advances are generally secured by loans. The Bancorp had loans of $10.6 billion and $10.9 billion at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, pledged at the FHLB, and loans of $34.1 billion and $33.5 billion at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, pledged at the FRB.

 

63


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

The following table presents a summary of the total loans and leases owned by the Bancorp as of:

 

                   90 Days Past Due  
     Balance      and Still Accruing  
     March 31,      December 31,      March 31,      December 31,  

($ in millions)

   2014      2013      2014      2013  

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 40,692        39,347      $ 1        —    

Commercial mortgage loans

     7,959        8,069        —          —    

Commercial construction loans

     1,220        1,041        —          —    

Commercial leases

     3,577        3,626        —          —    

Residential mortgage loans

     13,275        13,570        56        66  

Home equity

     9,125        9,246        —          —    

Automobile loans

     12,088        11,984        7        8  

Credit card

     2,177        2,294        30        29  

Other consumer loans and leases

     372        381        —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total loans and leases

   $ 90,485        89,558      $ 94        103  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Less: Loans held for sale

   $ 780        944        
  

 

 

    

 

 

       

Total portfolio loans and leases

   $ 89,705        88,614        
  

 

 

    

 

 

       

The following table presents a summary of net charge-offs:

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014      2013  

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 97        25  

Commercial mortgage loans

     3        26  

Commercial construction loans

     5        3  

Residential mortgage loans

     15        20  

Home equity

     16        30  

Automobile loans

     8        4  

Credit card

     19        20  

Other consumer loans and leases

     5        5  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 168        133  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

64


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

6. Credit Quality and the Allowance for Loan and Lease Losses

The Bancorp disaggregates ALLL balances and transactions in the ALLL by portfolio segment. Credit quality related disclosures for loans and leases are further disaggregated by class.

The following tables summarize transactions in the ALLL by portfolio segment:

 

For the three months ended March 31, 2014

($ in millions)

   Commercial     Residential
Mortgage
    Consumer     Unallocated     Total  

Transactions in the ALLL:

          

Balance, beginning of period

   $ 1,058       189       225       110       1,582  

Losses charged off

     (110     (19     (61     —         (190

Recoveries of losses previously charged off

     5       4       13       —         22  

Provision for loan and lease losses

     28       6       40       (5     69  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

   $ 981       180       217       105       1,483  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

For the three months ended March 31, 2013

($ in millions)

   Commercial     Residential
Mortgage
    Consumer     Unallocated     Total  

Transactions in the ALLL:

          

Balance, beginning of period

   $ 1,236       229       278       111       1,854  

Losses charged off

     (68     (22     (78     —         (168

Recoveries of losses previously charged off

     14       2       19       —         35  

Provision for loan and lease losses

     9       3       53       (3     62  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

   $ 1,191       212       272       108       1,783  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following tables provide a summary of the ALLL and related loans and leases classified by portfolio segment:

 

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

   Commercial     Residential
Mortgage
     Consumer      Unallocated      Total  

ALLL:(a)

             

Individually evaluated for impairment

   $ 182  (c)      140        51        —          373  

Collectively evaluated for impairment

     799       40        166        —          1,005  

Unallocated

     —         —          —          105        105  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total ALLL

   $ 981       180        217        105        1,483  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loans and leases:(b)

             

Individually evaluated for impairment

   $ 1,306  (c)      1,310        483        —          3,099  

Collectively evaluated for impairment

     52,038       11,209        23,252        —          86,499  

Loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality

     —         4        —          —          4  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total portfolio loans and leases

   $ 53,344       12,523        23,735        —          89,602  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Includes $8 related to leveraged leases.
(b) Excludes $103 of residential mortgage loans measured at fair value, and includes $878 of leveraged leases, net of unearned income.
(c) Includes five restructured loans at March 31, 2014 associated with a consolidated VIE in which the Bancorp has no continuing credit risk due to the risk being assumed by a third party, with a recorded investment of $28 and an allowance of $11.

 

As of December 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

   Commercial     Residential
Mortgage
     Consumer      Unallocated      Total  

ALLL:(a)

             

Individually evaluated for impairment

   $ 186  (c)       139        53        —          378  

Collectively evaluated for impairment

     872       50        172        —          1,094  

Unallocated

     —         —          —          110        110  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total ALLL

   $ 1,058       189        225        110        1,582  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loans and leases:(b)

             

Individually evaluated for impairment

   $ 1,560  (c)       1,325        496        —          3,381  

Collectively evaluated for impairment

     50,486       11,259        23,392        —          85,137  

Loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality

     —         4        —          —          4  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total portfolio loans and leases

   $ 52,046       12,588        23,888        —          88,522  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Includes $9 related to leveraged leases.
(b) Excludes $92 of residential mortgage loans measured at fair value, and includes $881 of leveraged leases, net of unearned income.
(c) Includes five restructured loans at December 31, 2013 associated with a consolidated VIE in which the Bancorp has no continuing credit risk due to the risk being assumed by a third party, with a recorded investment of $28 and an allowance of $11.

CREDIT RISK PROFILE

Commercial Portfolio Segment

For purposes of monitoring the credit quality and risk characteristics of its commercial portfolio segment, the Bancorp disaggregates the segment into the following classes: commercial and industrial, commercial mortgage owner-occupied, commercial mortgage non-owner occupied, commercial construction and commercial leasing.

 

65


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

To facilitate the monitoring of credit quality within the commercial portfolio segment, and for purposes of analyzing historical loss rates used in the determination of the ALLL for the commercial portfolio segment, the Bancorp utilizes the following categories of credit grades: pass, special mention, substandard, doubtful or loss. The five categories, which are derived from standard regulatory rating definitions, are assigned upon initial approval of credit to borrowers and updated periodically thereafter. Pass ratings, which are assigned to those borrowers that do not have identified potential or well defined weaknesses and for which there is a high likelihood of orderly repayment, are updated periodically based on the size and credit characteristics of the borrower. All other categories are updated on a quarterly basis during the month preceding the end of the calendar quarter.

The Bancorp assigns a special mention rating to loans and leases that have potential weaknesses that deserve management’s close attention. If left uncorrected, these potential weaknesses may, at some future date, result in the deterioration of the repayment prospects for the loan or lease or the Bancorp’s credit position.

The Bancorp assigns a substandard rating to loans and leases that are inadequately protected by the current sound worth and paying capacity of the borrower or of the collateral pledged. Substandard loans and leases have well defined weaknesses or weaknesses that could jeopardize the orderly repayment of the debt. Loans and leases in this grade also are characterized by the distinct possibility that the Bancorp will sustain some loss if the deficiencies noted are not addressed and corrected.

The Bancorp assigns a doubtful rating to loans and leases that have all the attributes of a substandard rating with the added characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions, and values, highly questionable and improbable. The possibility of loss is extremely high, but because of certain important and reasonable specific pending factors that may work to the advantage of and strengthen the credit quality of the loan or lease, its classification as an estimated loss is deferred until its more exact status may be determined. Pending factors may include a proposed merger or acquisition, liquidation proceeding, capital injection, perfecting liens on additional collateral or refinancing plans.

Loans and leases classified as loss are considered uncollectible and are charged off in the period in which they are determined to be uncollectible. Because loans and leases in this category are fully charged down, they are not included in the following tables.

The following table summarizes the credit risk profile of the Bancorp’s commercial portfolio segment, by class:

 

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

   Pass      Special
Mention
     Substandard      Doubtful      Total  

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 38,061        1,175        1,313        42        40,591  

Commercial mortgage owner occupied loans

     3,825        196        375        2        4,398  

Commercial mortgage non-owner occupied loans

     2,913        242        405        —          3,560  

Commercial construction loans

     1,078        37        103        —          1,218  

Commercial leases

     3,500        47        30        —          3,577  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 49,377        1,697        2,226        44        53,344  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

   Pass      Special
Mention
     Substandard      Doubtful      Total  

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 36,776        1,118        1,419        3        39,316  

Commercial mortgage owner occupied loans

     3,866        209        415        17        4,507  

Commercial mortgage non-owner occupied loans

     2,879        248        431        1        3,559  

Commercial construction loans

     855        32        152        —          1,039  

Commercial leases

     3,546        56        23        —          3,625  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 47,922        1,663        2,440        21        52,046  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Consumer Portfolio Segment

For purposes of monitoring the credit quality and risk characteristics of its consumer portfolio segment, the Bancorp disaggregates the segment into the following classes: home equity, automobile loans, credit card, and other consumer loans and leases. The Bancorp’s residential mortgage portfolio segment is also a separate class.

The Bancorp considers repayment performance as the best indicator of credit quality for residential mortgage and consumer loans, which includes both the delinquency status and performing versus nonperforming status of the loans. The delinquency status of all residential mortgage and consumer loans is presented by class in the age analysis section below while the performing versus nonperforming status is presented in the table below. Refer to the nonaccrual section of Note 1 in the Bancorp’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013 for additional delinquency and nonperforming information.

 

66


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

The following table presents a summary of the Bancorp’s residential mortgage and consumer portfolio segments disaggregated into performing versus nonperforming status as of:

 

     March 31, 2014      December 31, 2013  

($ in millions)

   Performing      Nonperforming      Performing      Nonperforming  

Residential mortgage loans(a)

   $ 12,382        141        12,423        165  

Home equity

     9,031        94        9,153        93  

Automobile loans

     12,087        1        11,982        2  

Credit card

     2,144        33        2,261        33  

Other consumer loans and leases

     345        —          364        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 35,989        269        36,183        293  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Excludes $103 and $92 of loans measured at fair value at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.

Age Analysis of Past Due Loans and Leases

The following tables summarize the Bancorp’s recorded investment in portfolio loans and leases by age and class:

 

            Past Due                

As of March 31, 2014

($ in millions)

   Current
Loans and
Leases(c)
     30-89
Days(c)
     90 Days
and
Greater(c)
     Total
Past Due
     Total Loans
and Leases
     90 Days Past
Due and Still
Accruing
 

Commercial:

                 

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 40,402        35        154        189        40,591        1  

Commercial mortgage owner occupied loans

     4,321        10        67        77        4,398        —    

Commercial mortgage non-owner occupied loans

     3,524        4        32        36        3,560        —    

Commercial construction loans

     1,199        15        4        19        1,218        —    

Commercial leases

     3,573        2        2        4        3,577        —    

Residential mortgage loans(a) (b)

     12,255        71        197        268        12,523        56  

Consumer:

                 

Home equity

     8,947        99        79        178        9,125        —    

Automobile loans

     12,037        42        9        51        12,088        7  

Credit card

     2,111        31        35        66        2,177        30  

Other consumer loans and leases

     344        1        —          1        345        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total portfolio loans and leases(a)

   $ 88,713        310        579        889        89,602        94  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Excludes $103 of loans measured at fair value.
(b) Information for current residential mortgage loans includes loans whose repayments are insured by the Federal Housing Administration or guaranteed by the Department of Veterans Affairs. As of March 31, 2014, $75 of these loans were 30-89 days past due and $347 were 90 days or more past due. The Bancorp recognized $5 of losses during the three months ended March 31, 2014 due to claim denials and curtailments associated with these loans.
(c) Includes accrual and nonaccrual loans and leases.

 

            Past Due                

As of December 31, 2013

($ in millions)

   Current
Loans and
Leases(c)
     30-89
Days(c)
     90 Days
and
Greater(c)
     Total
Past Due
     Total Loans
and Leases
     90 Days Past
Due and Still
Accruing
 

Commercial:

                 

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 39,118        53        145        198        39,316        —    

Commercial mortgage owner occupied loans

     4,423        15        69        84        4,507        —    

Commercial mortgage non-owner occupied loans

     3,515        9        35        44        3,559        —    

Commercial construction loans

     1,010        —          29        29        1,039        —    

Commercial leases

     3,620        —          5        5        3,625        —    

Residential mortgage loans(a) (b)

     12,284        73        231        304        12,588        66  

Consumer:

                 

Home equity

     9,058        102        86        188        9,246        —    

Automobile loans

     11,919        55        10        65        11,984        8  

Credit card

     2,225        36        33        69        2,294        29  

Other consumer loans and leases

     362        2        —          2        364        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total portfolio loans and leases(a)

   $ 87,534        345        643        988        88,522        103  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Excludes $92 of loans measured at fair value.
(b) Information for current residential mortgage loans includes loans whose repayments are insured by the Federal Housing Administration or guaranteed by the Department of Veterans Affairs. As of December 31, 2013, $81 of these loans were 30-89 days past due and $378 were 90 days or more past due. The Bancorp recognized $5 of losses for the year ended December 31, 2013 due to claim denials and curtailments associated with these loans.
(c) Includes accrual and nonaccrual loans and leases.

 

67


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

Impaired Loans and Leases

Larger commercial loans and leases included within aggregate borrower relationship balances exceeding $1 million that exhibit probable or observed credit weaknesses are subject to individual review for impairment. The Bancorp also performs an individual review on loans and leases that are restructured in a troubled debt restructuring. The Bancorp considers the current value of collateral, credit quality of any guarantees, the loan structure, and other factors when evaluating whether an individual loan or lease is impaired. Other factors may include the geography and industry of the borrower, size and financial condition of the borrower, cash flow and leverage of the borrower, and the Bancorp’s evaluation of the borrower’s management. Smaller-balance homogenous loans or leases that are collectively evaluated for impairment are not included in the following tables.

The following tables summarize the Bancorp’s impaired loans and leases (by class) that were subject to individual review, which includes all loans and leases restructured in a troubled debt restructuring:

 

As of March 31, 2014

($ in millions)

   Unpaid
Principal
Balance
     Recorded
Investment
    Allowance  

With a related allowance recorded:

       

Commercial:

       

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 663        531       140  

Commercial mortgage owner occupied loans(b)

     85        71       11  

Commercial mortgage non-owner occupied loans

     105        82       12  

Commercial construction loans

     76        60       5  

Commercial leases

     3        3       3  

Restructured residential mortgage loans

     1,074        1,044       140  

Restructured consumer:

       

Home equity

     366        363       36  

Automobile loans

     22        21       3  

Credit card

     57        57       12  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total impaired loans and leases with a related allowance

   $ 2,451        2,232       362  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

With no related allowance recorded:

       

Commercial:

       

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 242        198       —    

Commercial mortgage owner occupied loans

     90        82       —    

Commercial mortgage non-owner occupied loans

     191        185       —    

Commercial construction loans

     64        52       —    

Commercial leases

     14        14       —    

Restructured residential mortgage loans

     300        266       —    

Restructured consumer:

       

Home equity

     43        39       —    

Automobile loans

     3        3       —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total impaired loans and leases with no related allowance

     947        839       —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total impaired loans and leases

   $ 3,398        3,071  (a)      362  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Includes $847, $1,237 and $430, respectively, of commercial, residential mortgage and consumer TDRs on accrual status; $209, $73 and $53, respectively, of commercial, residential mortgage and consumer TDRs on nonaccrual status.
(b) Excludes five restructured loans at March 31, 2014 associated with a consolidated VIE in which the Bancorp has no continuing credit risk due to the risk being assumed by a third party, with an unpaid principal balance of $28, a recorded investment of $28, and an allowance of $11.

 

68


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

As of December 31, 2013

($ in millions)

   Unpaid
Principal
Balance
     Recorded
Investment
    Allowance  

With a related allowance recorded:

       

Commercial:

       

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 870        759       145  

Commercial mortgage owner occupied loans(b)

     85        74       11  

Commercial mortgage non-owner occupied loans

     154        134       14  

Commercial construction loans

     68        54       5  

Commercial leases

     12        12       —    

Restructured residential mortgage loans

     1,081        1,052       139  

Restructured consumer:

       

Home equity

     377        373       39  

Automobile loans

     23        23       3  

Credit card

     59        58       11  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total impaired loans and leases with a related allowance

   $ 2,729        2,539       367  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

With no related allowance recorded:

       

Commercial:

       

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 181        177       —    

Commercial mortgage owner occupied loans

     106        98       —    

Commercial mortgage non-owner occupied loans

     154        147       —    

Commercial construction loans

     77        63       —    

Commercial leases

     14        14       —    

Restructured residential mortgage loans

     313        273       —    

Restructured consumer:

       

Home equity

     43        39       —    

Automobile loans

     3        3       —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total impaired loans and leases with no related allowance

     891        814       —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total impaired loans and leases

   $ 3,620        3,353  (a)      367  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Includes $869, $1,241 and $444, respectively, of commercial, residential mortgage and consumer TDRs on accrual status; $228, $84 and $52, respectively, of commercial, residential mortgage and consumer TDRs on nonaccrual status.
(b) Excludes five restructured loans at December 31, 2013 associated with a consolidated VIE in which the Bancorp has no continuing credit risk due to the risk being assumed by a third party, with an unpaid principal balance of $28, a recorded investment of $28, and an allowance of $11.

The following table summarizes the Bancorp’s average impaired loans and leases and interest income by class:

 

     For the three months ended
March 31, 2014
     For the three months ended
March 31, 2013
 

($ in millions)

   Average
Recorded
Investment
     Interest
Income
Recognized
     Average
Recorded
Investment
     Interest
Income
Recognized
 

Commercial:

           

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 832        5      $ 339        2  

Commercial mortgage owner occupied loans(a)

     162        1        140        1  

Commercial mortgage non-owner occupied loans

     273        2        341        2  

Commercial construction loans

     114        —          110        1  

Commercial leases

     22        —          11        —    

Restructured residential mortgage loans

     1,312        13        1,306        13  

Restructured consumer:

           

Home equity

     406        5        439        6  

Automobile loans

     24        —          32        —    

Credit card

     57        1        73        1  

Other consumer loans and leases

     —          —          2        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total impaired loans and leases

   $ 3,202        27      $ 2,793        26  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Excludes five restructured loans associated with a consolidated variable interest entity in which the Bancorp has no continuing credit risk due to the risk being assumed by a third party, with an average recorded investment of $28 and $30 at March 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

 

69


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

Nonperforming Assets

Nonperforming assets include nonaccrual loans and leases for which ultimate collectability of the full amount of the principal and/or interest is uncertain; restructured commercial and credit card loans which have not yet met the requirements to be classified as a performing asset; restructured consumer loans which are 90 days past due based on the restructured terms unless the loan is both well-secured and in the process of collection; and certain other assets, including OREO and other repossessed property. The following table summarizes the Bancorp’s nonperforming loans and leases, by class, as of:

 

($ in millions)

   March 31,
2014
     December 31,
2013
 

Commercial:

     

Commercial and industrial loans

   $ 297        281  

Commercial mortgage owner occupied loans(a)

     87        95  

Commercial mortgage non-owner occupied loans

     59        48  

Commercial construction loans

     17        29  

Commercial leases

     4        5  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total commercial loans and leases

     464        458  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Residential mortgage loans

     141        166  

Consumer:

     

Home equity

     94        93  

Automobile loans

     1        1  

Credit card

     33        33  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total consumer loans and leases

     128        127  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total nonperforming loans and leases(b) (c)

   $ 733        751  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

OREO and other repossessed property(d)

     213        229  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Excludes $21 of restructured nonaccrual loans at both March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013 associated with a consolidated VIE in which the Bancorp has no continuing credit risk due to the risk being assumed by a third party.
(b) Excludes $3 and $6 of nonaccrual loans held for sale at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.
(c) Includes $9 and $10 of nonaccrual government insured commercial loans whose repayments are insured by the SBA at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, and $2 of restructured nonaccrual government insured commercial loans at both March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.
(d) Excludes $85 and $77 of OREO related to government insured loans at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.

Troubled Debt Restructurings

If a borrower is experiencing financial difficulty, the Bancorp may consider, in certain circumstances, modifying the terms of their loan to maximize collection of amounts due. Within each of the Bancorp’s loan classes, TDRs typically involve either a reduction of the stated interest rate of the loan, an extension of the loan’s maturity date(s) with a stated rate lower than the current market rate for a new loan with similar risk, or in limited circumstances, a reduction of the principal balance of the loan or the loan’s accrued interest. Modifying the terms of loans may result in an increase or decrease to the ALLL depending upon the terms modified, the method used to measure the ALLL for a loan prior to modification, and whether any charge-offs were recorded on the loan before or at the time of modification. Refer to the ALLL section of Note 1 in the Bancorp’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013 for information on the Bancorp’s ALLL methodology. Upon modification of a loan, the Bancorp measures the related impairment as the difference between the estimated future cash flows, discounted at the original effective yield of the loan, expected to be collected on the modified loan and the carrying value of the loan. The resulting measurement may result in the need for minimal or no valuation allowance because it is probable that all cash flows will be collected under the modified terms of the loan. In addition, if the stated interest rate was increased in a TDR, the cash flows on the modified loan, using the pre-modification interest rate as the discount rate, often exceed the recorded investment of the loan. Conversely, the Bancorp often recognizes an impairment loss as an increase to the ALLL upon a modification that reduces the stated interest rate on a loan.

If a TDR involves a reduction of the principal balance of the loan or the loan’s accrued interest, that amount is charged off to the ALLL. As of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the Bancorp had $49 million and $46 million in line of credit commitments and $37 million and $40 million in letter of credit commitments, respectively, to lend additional funds to borrowers whose terms have been modified in a TDR.

 

70


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

The following table provides a summary of loans modified in a TDR by the Bancorp during the three months ended:

 

March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)(a)

   Number of loans
modified in a TDR
during the period
(b)
     Recorded investment
in loans modified in
a TDR

during the period
     Increase
(Decrease)
to ALLL upon
modification
    Charge-offs
recognized upon
modification
 

Commercial:

          

Commercial and industrial loans

     22      $ 19        (4     —    

Commercial mortgage owner occupied loans

     16        12        (1     —    

Commercial mortgage non-owner occupied loans

     7        6        (1     —    

Residential mortgage loans

     310        45        3       —    

Consumer:

          

Home equity

     35        1        —         —    

Automobile loans

     116        2        —         —    

Credit card

     1,951        12        2       —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total portfolio loans and leases

     2,457      $ 97        (1     —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

March 31, 2013 ($ in millions)(a)

   Number of loans
modified in a TDR
during the period(b)
     Recorded investment
in loans modified in

a TDR
during the period
     Increase
(Decrease)
to ALLL upon
modification
    Charge-offs
recognized upon
modification
 

Commercial:

          

Commercial and industrial loans

     20      $ 9        1       1  

Commercial mortgage owner occupied loans(c)

     10        4        (1     —    

Commercial mortgage non-owner occupied loans

     15        17        (1     —    

Commercial construction loans

     1        6        (1     —    

Residential mortgage loans

     394        61        8       —    

Consumer:

          

Home equity

     326        17        —         —    

Automobile loans

     115        7        —         —    

Credit card

     2,312        14        2       —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total portfolio loans and leases

     3,193      $ 135        8       1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Excludes all loans and leases held for sale and loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality.
(b) Represents number of loans post-modification.
(c) Excludes five loans modified in a TDR during the three months ended March 31, 2013 associated with a consolidated VIE in which the Bancorp has no continuing credit risk due to the risk being assumed by a third party. The TDR had a recorded investment of $29, ALLL increased $7 upon modification, and a charge-off of $2 was recognized upon modification.

The Bancorp considers TDRs that become 90 days or more past due under the modified terms as subsequently defaulted. For commercial loans not subject to individual review for impairment, the historical loss rates that are applied to such commercial loans for purposes of determining the allowance include historical losses associated with subsequent defaults on loans previously modified in a TDR. For consumer loans, the Bancorp performs a qualitative assessment of the adequacy of the consumer ALLL by comparing the consumer ALLL to forecasted consumer losses over the projected loss emergence period (the forecasted losses include the impact of subsequent defaults of consumer TDRs). When a residential mortgage, home equity, auto or other consumer loan that has been modified in a TDR subsequently defaults, the present value of expected cash flows used in the measurement of the potential impairment loss is generally limited to the expected net proceeds from the sale of the loan’s underlying collateral and any resulting impairment loss is reflected as a charge-off or an increase in ALLL. When a credit card loan that has been modified in a TDR subsequently defaults, the calculation of the impairment loss is consistent with the Bancorp’s calculation for other credit card loans that have become 90 days or more past due.

 

71


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

The following table provides a summary of subsequent defaults of TDRs that occurred during the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013 and within 12 months of the restructuring date:

 

March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)(a)

   Number of
Contracts
     Recorded
Investment
 

Commercial:

     

Commercial and industrial loans

     6      $ 14  

Commercial mortgage owner-occupied loans

     2        3  

Residential mortgage loans

     41        6  

Consumer:

     

Home equity

     10        —    

Automobile loans

     2        —    

Credit card

     507        3  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total portfolio loans and leases

     568      $ 26  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

March 31, 2013 ($ in millions)(a)

   Number of
Contracts
     Recorded
Investment
 

Residential mortgage loans

     42      $ 8  

Consumer:

     

Home equity

     14        1  

Automobile loans

     3        —    

Credit card

     515        3  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total portfolio loans and leases

     574      $ 12  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Excludes all loans and leases held for sale and loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality.

 

72


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

7. Intangible Assets

Intangible assets consist of core deposit intangibles, customer lists, non-compete agreements and cardholder relationships. Intangible assets are amortized on either a straight-line or an accelerated basis over their estimated useful lives. Intangible assets have an estimated remaining weighted-average life at March 31, 2014 of 4.3 years.

The details of the Bancorp’s intangible assets are shown in the following table:

 

($ in millions)

   Gross Carrying
Amount
     Accumulated
Amortization
    Net Carrying
Amount
 

As of March 31, 2014

       

Core deposit intangibles

   $ 122        (109     13  

Other

     45        (40     5  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total intangible assets

   $ 167        (149     18  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2013

       

Core deposit intangibles

   $ 154        (141     13  

Other

     45        (39     6  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total intangible assets

   $ 199        (180     19  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of March 31, 2014, all of the Bancorp’s intangible assets were being amortized. Amortization expense recognized on intangible assets for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013 was $1 million and $2 million, respectively.

The Bancorp’s projections of amortization expense shown below are based on existing asset balances as of March 31, 2014. Future amortization expense may vary from these projections. Estimated amortization expense for the remainder of 2014 through 2018 is as follows:

 

($ in millions)

   Total  

Remainder of 2014

   $ 3  

2015

     2  

2016

     2  

2017

     2  

2018

     2  
  

 

 

 

 

73


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

8. Variable Interest Entities

The Bancorp, in the normal course of business, engages in a variety of activities that involve VIEs, which are legal entities that lack sufficient equity to finance their activities, or the equity investors of the entities as a group lack any of the characteristics of a controlling interest. The primary beneficiary of a VIE is generally the enterprise that has both the power to direct the activities most significant to the economic performance of the VIE and the obligation to absorb losses or receive benefits that could potentially be significant to the VIE. For certain investment funds, the primary beneficiary is the enterprise that will absorb a majority of the fund’s expected losses or receive a majority of the fund’s expected residual returns. The Bancorp evaluates its interest in certain entities to determine if these entities meet the definition of a VIE and whether the Bancorp is the primary beneficiary and should consolidate the entity based on the variable interests it held both at inception and when there is a change in circumstances that requires a reconsideration. If the Bancorp is determined to be the primary beneficiary of a VIE, it must account for the VIE as a consolidated subsidiary. If the Bancorp is determined not to be the primary beneficiary of a VIE but holds a variable interest in the entity, such variable interests are accounted for under the equity method of accounting or other accounting standards as appropriate.

Consolidated VIEs

The following table provides a summary of the classifications of consolidated VIE assets, liabilities and noncontrolling interests included in the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets as of:

 

March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

   Automobile
Loan
Securitizations
    CDC
Investments
    Total  

Assets:

      

Cash and due from banks

   $ 102       —         102  

Other short-term investments

     7       —         7  

Commercial mortgage loans

     —         48       48  

Automobile loans(a)

     2,031       —         2,031  

ALLL

     (5     (13     (18

Other assets

     20       3       23  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

     2,155       38       2,193  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities:

      

Other liabilities

   $ 3       —         3  

Long-term debt

     2,119       —         2,119  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

   $ 2,122       —         2,122  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncontrolling interests

     —         38       38  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

December 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

   Automobile
Loan
Securitization
    CDC
Investments
    Total  

Assets:

      

Cash and due from banks

   $ 49       —         49  

Commercial mortgage loans

     —         48       48  

Automobile loans(a)

     1,010       —         1,010  

ALLL

     (2     (13     (15

Other assets

     11       2       13  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 1,068       37       1,105  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities

      

Other liabilities

   $ 1       —         1  

Long-term debt

     1,048       —         1,048  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

   $ 1,049       —         1,049  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncontrolling interests

     —         37       37  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Net of $98 and $52 of unamortized fees and discounts at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.

Automobile Loan Securitizations

In securitizations that occurred in August of 2013 and February of 2014, the Bancorp transferred an aggregate amount of $2.5 billion in fixed-rate consumer automobile loans to bankruptcy remote trusts which were deemed to be VIEs. The primary purposes for which the VIEs were created was to issue asset-backed securities with varying levels of credit subordination and payment priority, as well as residual interests, and to provide the Bancorp with access to liquidity for its originated loans. The Bancorp retained residual interests in the VIEs and, therefore, has an obligation to absorb losses and a right to receive benefits from the VIEs that could potentially be significant to the VIEs. In addition, the Bancorp retained servicing rights for the underlying loans and, therefore, holds the power to direct the activities of the VIEs that most significantly impact the economic performance of the VIEs. As a result, the Bancorp concluded that it is the primary beneficiary of the VIEs and, therefore, has consolidated these VIEs. The assets of the VIEs are restricted to the settlement of the notes and other obligations of the VIEs. Third-party holders of the notes do not have recourse to the general assets of the Bancorp.

The economic performance of the VIEs is most significantly impacted by the performance of the underlying loans. The principal risks to which the VIEs are exposed include credit risk and prepayment risk. The credit and prepayment risks are managed through credit enhancements in the form of reserve accounts, overcollateralization, excess interest on the loans and the subordination of certain classes of asset-backed securities to other classes.

 

74


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

CDC Investments

CDC, a wholly-owned indirect subsidiary of the Bancorp, was created to invest in projects to create affordable housing, revitalize business and residential areas, and preserve historic landmarks. CDC generally co-invests with other unrelated companies and/or individuals and typically makes investments in a separate legal entity that owns the property under development. The entities are usually formed as limited partnerships and LLCs, and CDC typically invests as a limited partner/investor member in the form of equity contributions. The economic performance of the VIEs is driven by the performance of their underlying investment projects as well as the VIEs’ ability to operate in compliance with the rules and regulations necessary for the qualification of tax credits generated by equity investments. Typically, the general partner or managing member will be the party that has the right to make decisions that will most significantly impact the economic performance of the entity. The Bancorp’s subsidiaries serve as the managing member of certain LLCs invested in business revitalization projects. The Bancorp has provided an indemnification guarantee to the investor member of these LLCs related to the qualification of tax credits generated by the investor member’s investment. Accordingly, the Bancorp concluded that it is the primary beneficiary and, therefore, has consolidated these VIEs. As a result, the investor members’ interests in these VIEs are presented as noncontrolling interests in the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements. This presentation includes reporting separately the equity attributable to the noncontrolling interests in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets and Condensed Consolidated Statements of Changes in Equity and reporting separately the comprehensive income attributable to the noncontrolling interests in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income and the net income attributable to the noncontrolling interests in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income. The Bancorp’s maximum exposure related to these indemnifications at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013 was $21 million, which is based on an amount required to meet the investor member’s defined target rate of return.

Non-consolidated VIEs

The following tables provide a summary of assets and liabilities carried on the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets related to non-consolidated VIEs for which the Bancorp holds an interest, but is not the primary beneficiary of the VIE, as well as the Bancorp’s maximum exposure to losses associated with its interests in the entities:

 

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

   Total
Assets
     Total
Liabilities
     Maximum
Exposure
 

CDC investments

   $ 1,418        369        1,418  

Private equity investments

     209        —          304  

Loans provided to VIEs

     1,843        —          2,807  

Automobile loan securitization

     3        —          3  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

   Total
Assets
     Total
Liabilities
     Maximum
Exposure
 

CDC investments

   $ 1,436        407        1,436  

Private equity investments

     204        —          294  

Loans provided to VIEs

     1,830        —          2,792  

Automobile loan securitization

     4        —          4  

Restructured loans

     1        —          1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

CDC Investments

As noted previously, CDC typically invests in VIEs as a limited partner or investor member in the form of equity contributions. The Bancorp has determined that it is not the primary beneficiary of these VIEs because it lacks the power to direct the activities that most significantly impact the economic performance of the underlying project or the VIEs’ ability to operate in compliance with the rules and regulations necessary for the qualification of tax credits generated by equity investments. This power is held by the general partners/managing members who exercise full and exclusive control of the operations of the VIEs. Accordingly, the Bancorp accounts for these investments under the equity method of accounting.

The Bancorp’s funding requirements are limited to its invested capital and any additional unfunded commitments for future equity contributions. The Bancorp’s maximum exposure to loss as a result of its involvement with the VIEs is limited to the carrying amounts of the investments, including the unfunded commitments. The carrying amounts of these investments, which are included in other assets in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets, and the liabilities related to the unfunded commitments, which are included in other liabilities in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets, are included in the previous tables for all periods presented. The Bancorp has no other liquidity arrangements or obligations to purchase assets of the VIEs that would expose the Bancorp to a loss. In certain arrangements, the general partner/managing member of the VIE has guaranteed a level of projected tax credits to be received by the limited partners/investor members, thereby minimizing a portion of the Bancorp’s risk.

Private Equity Investments

The Bancorp invests as a limited partner in private equity funds which provide the Bancorp an opportunity to obtain higher rates of return on invested capital, while also creating cross-selling opportunities for the Bancorp’s commercial products. Each of the limited partnerships has an unrelated third-party general partner responsible for appointing the fund manager. The Bancorp has not been appointed fund manager for any of these private equity funds. The funds finance primarily all of their activities from the partners’ capital contributions and investment returns. Under the VIE consolidation guidance still applicable to the funds, the Bancorp has determined that it is not the primary beneficiary of the funds because it does not absorb a majority of the funds’ expected losses or receive a majority of the funds’ expected residual returns. Therefore, the Bancorp accounts for its investments in these limited partnerships under the equity method of accounting.

 

75


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

The Bancorp is exposed to losses arising from the negative performance of the underlying investments in the private equity funds. As a limited partner, the Bancorp’s maximum exposure to loss is limited to the carrying amounts of the investments plus unfunded commitments. The carrying amounts of these investments, which are included in other assets in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets, are included in the previous tables. Also, as of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the unfunded commitment amounts to the funds were $95 million and $90 million, respectively. The Bancorp made capital contributions of $7 million and $3 million, respectively, to private equity funds during the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013.

Loans Provided to VIEs

The Bancorp has provided funding to certain unconsolidated VIEs sponsored by third parties. These VIEs are generally established to finance certain consumer and small business loans originated by third parties. The entities are primarily funded through the issuance of a loan from the Bancorp or a syndication through which the Bancorp is involved. The sponsor/administrator of the entities is responsible for servicing the underlying assets in the VIEs. Because the sponsor/administrator, not the Bancorp, holds the servicing responsibilities, which include the establishment and employment of default mitigation policies and procedures, the Bancorp does not hold the power to direct the activities most significant to the economic performance of the entity and, therefore, is not the primary beneficiary.

The principal risk to which these entities are exposed is credit risk related to the underlying assets. The Bancorp’s maximum exposure to loss is equal to the carrying amounts of the loans and unfunded commitments to the VIEs. The Bancorp’s outstanding loans to these VIEs, included in commercial loans in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets, are included in the previous tables for all periods presented. Also, as of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the Bancorp’s unfunded commitments to these entities were $964 million and $962 million, respectively. The loans and unfunded commitments to these VIEs are included in the Bancorp’s overall analysis of the ALLL and reserve for unfunded commitments, respectively. The Bancorp does not provide any implicit or explicit liquidity guarantees or principal value guarantees to these VIEs.

Automobile Loan Securitization

In March of 2013, the Bancorp recognized an immaterial loss on the securitization and sale of certain automobile loans with a carrying amount of approximately $509 million. The securitization and the resulting sale of all underlying securities qualified for sale accounting. The Bancorp has concluded that it is not the primary beneficiary of the trust because it has neither the obligation to absorb losses of the entity that could potentially be significant to the VIE nor the right to receive benefits from the entity that could potentially be significant to the VIE. The Bancorp is not required and does not currently intend to provide any additional financial support to the trust. Investors and creditors only have recourse to the assets held by the trust. The interest the Bancorp holds in the VIE relates to servicing rights which are included in the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. The maximum exposure to loss is equal to the carrying value of the servicing asset.

Restructured Loans

As part of loan restructuring efforts, the Bancorp received equity capital from certain borrowers to facilitate the restructuring of the borrower’s debt. These borrowers met the definition of a VIE because the Bancorp was involved in their refinancing and because their equity capital was insufficient to fund ongoing operations. The Bancorp accounted for its equity investments in these VIEs under the equity method or cost method based on its percentage of ownership and ability to exercise significant influence.

The Bancorp’s maximum exposure to loss as a result of its involvement with these VIEs was limited to the equity investments, the principal and accrued interest on the outstanding loans, and any unfunded commitments. The Bancorp had outstanding loans to these VIEs, included in commercial loans in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. The Bancorp had no unfunded loan commitments to these VIEs as of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013. The loans to these VIEs are included in the Bancorp’s overall analysis of the ALLL. The Bancorp does not provide any implicit or explicit liquidity guarantees or principal value guarantees to these VIEs.

9. Sales of Receivables and Servicing Rights

Automobile Loan Securitization

In March of 2013, the Bancorp recognized an immaterial loss on the securitization and sale of certain automobile loans with a carrying amount of approximately $509 million. The Bancorp utilized a securitization trust to facilitate the securitization process. The trust issued asset-backed securities in the form of notes and equity certificates, with varying levels of credit subordination and payment priority. The Bancorp does not hold any of the notes or equity certificates issued by the trust, and the investors in these securities have no credit recourse to the Bancorp’s assets for failure of debtors to pay when due. As part of the sale, the Bancorp obtained servicing responsibilities and recognized a servicing asset with an initial fair value of $6 million.

Residential Mortgage Loan Sales

The Bancorp sold fixed and adjustable rate residential mortgage loans during the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013. In those sales, the Bancorp obtained servicing responsibilities and the investors have no recourse to the Bancorp’s other assets for failure of debtors to pay when due. The Bancorp receives annual servicing fees based on a percentage of the outstanding balance. The Bancorp identifies classes of servicing assets based on financial asset type and interest rates.

 

76


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

Information related to residential mortgage loan sales and the Bancorp’s mortgage banking activity, which is included in mortgage banking net revenue in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income, is as follows:

 

      For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014      2013  

Residential mortgage loan sales

   $ 1,672        6,888  

Origination fees and gains on loan sales

     41        169  

Gross mortgage servicing fees

     62        61  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Servicing Rights

The following table presents changes in the servicing rights related to residential mortgage and automobile loans for the three months ended March 31:

 

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Carrying amount before valuation allowance as of the beginning of the period

   $ 1,440       1,358  

Servicing rights that result from the transfer of residential mortgage loans

     23       73  

Servicing rights that result from the transfer of automobile loans

     —         6  

Amortization

     (23     (53
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Carrying amount before valuation allowance

     1,440       1,384  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Valuation allowance for servicing rights:

    

Beginning balance

     (469     (661

Recovery of MSR impairment

     4       49  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

     (465     (612
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Carrying amount as of the end of the period

   $ 975       772  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The Bancorp’s projections of amortization expense shown below are based on existing asset balances as of March 31, 2014. Future amortization expense may vary from these projections. Estimated amortization expense for the remainder of 2014 through 2018 is as follows:

 

($ in millions)

   Total  

Remainder of 2014

   $ 71  

2015

     89  

2016

     82  

2017

     77  

2018

     72  
  

 

 

 

Temporary impairment or impairment recovery, affected through a change in the MSR valuation allowance, is captured as a component of mortgage banking net revenue in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income. The Bancorp maintains a non-qualifying hedging strategy to manage a portion of the risk associated with changes in the value of the MSR portfolio. This strategy includes the purchase of free-standing derivatives and various available-for-sale securities. The interest income, mark-to-market adjustments and gain or loss from sale activities associated with these portfolios are expected to economically hedge a portion of the change in value of the MSR portfolio caused by fluctuating discount rates, earnings rates and prepayment speeds. The fair value of the servicing asset is based on the present value of expected future cash flows.

The following table displays the beginning and ending fair value of the servicing assets for the three months ended March 31:

 

($ in millions)

   2014      2013  

Fixed rate residential mortgage loans:

     

Beginning balance

   $ 929        664  

Ending balance

     935        731  

Adjustable rate residential mortgage loans:

     

Beginning balance

     38        33  

Ending balance

     37        35  

Fixed rate automobile loans:

     

Beginning balance

     4        —    

Ending balance

     3        6  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

77


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

The following table presents activity related to valuations of the MSR portfolio and the impact of the non-qualifying hedging strategy, which is included in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income:

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014      2013  

Securities gains, net - non-qualifying hedges on MSRs

   $ —          2  

Changes in fair value and settlement of free-standing derivatives purchased to economically hedge the MSR portfolio (Mortgage banking net revenue)

     24        (6

Recovery of MSR impairment (Mortgage banking net revenue)

     4        49  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of March 31, 2014 and 2013, the key economic assumptions used in measuring the interests in residential mortgage loans that continued to be held by the Bancorp at the date of sale or securitization resulting from transactions completed during the three months ended were as follows:

 

        March 31, 2014     March 31, 2013  
    Rate   Weighted-
Average
Life (in
years)
    Prepayment
Speed
(annual)
    Discount
Rate
(annual)
    Weighted-
Average
Default
rate
    Weighted-
Average
Life (in
years)
    Prepayment
Speed
(annual)
    Discount
Rate
(annual)
    Weighted-
Average
Default
rate
 

Residential mortgage loans:

                 

Servicing assets

  Fixed     6.7       10.8      10.0      N/A        7.3       8.8      10.0      N/A   

Servicing assets

  Adjustable     3.7       22.5       11.7       N/A        3.5       23.4       11.4       N/A   
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Based on historical credit experience, expected credit losses for residential mortgage loan servicing assets have been deemed immaterial, as the Bancorp sold the majority of the underlying loans without recourse. At March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the Bancorp serviced $68.9 billion and $69.2 billion, respectively, of residential mortgage loans for other investors. The value of MSRs that continue to be held by the Bancorp is subject to credit, prepayment and interest rate risks on the sold financial assets.

At March 31, 2014, the sensitivity of the current fair value of residual cash flows to immediate 10%, 20% and 50% adverse changes in prepayment speed assumptions and immediate 10% and 20% adverse changes in other assumptions are as follows:

 

                          Prepayment Speed
Assumption
    Residual Servicing
Cash Flows
 
             Fair      Weighted-
Average
Life (in
           Impact of Adverse
Change on Fair Value
    Discount     Impact of
Adverse Change
on Fair Value
 

($ in millions)(a)

   Rate      Value      years)      Rate     10%     20%     50%     Rate     10%     20%  

Residential mortgage loans:

                       

Servicing assets

     Fixed       $ 935        6.6        10.6    $ (37     (72     (163     9.9    $ (36     (69

Servicing assets

     Adjustable         37        3.1        26.1       (2     (3     (7     11.8       (1     (2

 

(a) The impact of the weighted-average default rate on the current fair value of residual cash flows for all scenarios is immaterial.

These sensitivities are hypothetical and should be used with caution. As the figures indicate, changes in fair value based on these variations in the assumptions typically cannot be extrapolated because the relationship of the change in assumption to the change in fair value may not be linear. The Bancorp believes variations of these levels are reasonably possible; however, there is the potential that adverse changes in key assumptions could be even greater. Also, in the previous table, the effect of a variation in a particular assumption on the fair value of the interests that continue to be held by the Bancorp is calculated without changing any other assumption; in reality, changes in one factor may result in changes in another (for example, increases in market interest rates may result in lower prepayments), which might magnify or counteract these sensitivities.

 

78


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

10. Derivative Financial Instruments

The Bancorp maintains an overall risk management strategy that incorporates the use of derivative instruments to reduce certain risks related to interest rate, prepayment and foreign currency volatility. Additionally, the Bancorp holds derivative instruments for the benefit of its commercial customers and for other business purposes. The Bancorp does not enter into unhedged speculative derivative positions.

The Bancorp’s interest rate risk management strategy involves modifying the repricing characteristics of certain financial instruments so that changes in interest rates do not adversely affect the Bancorp’s net interest margin and cash flows. Derivative instruments that the Bancorp may use as part of its interest rate risk management strategy include interest rate swaps, interest rate floors, interest rate caps, forward contracts, options and swaptions. Interest rate swap contracts are exchanges of interest payments, such as fixed-rate payments for floating-rate payments, based on a stated notional amount and maturity date. Interest rate floors protect against declining rates, while interest rate caps protect against rising interest rates. Forward contracts are contracts in which the buyer agrees to purchase, and the seller agrees to make delivery of, a specific financial instrument at a predetermined price or yield. Options provide the purchaser with the right, but not the obligation, to purchase or sell a contracted item during a specified period at an agreed upon price. Swaptions are financial instruments granting the owner the right, but not the obligation, to enter into or cancel a swap.

Prepayment volatility arises mostly from changes in fair value of the largely fixed-rate MSR portfolio, mortgage loans and mortgage-backed securities. The Bancorp may enter into various free-standing derivatives (principal-only swaps, interest rate swaptions, interest rate floors, mortgage options, TBAs and interest rate swaps) to economically hedge prepayment volatility. Principal-only swaps are total return swaps based on changes in the value of the underlying mortgage principal-only trust. TBAs are a forward purchase agreement for a mortgage-backed securities trade whereby the terms of the security are undefined at the time the trade is made.

Foreign currency volatility occurs as the Bancorp enters into certain loans denominated in foreign currencies. Derivative instruments that the Bancorp may use to economically hedge these foreign denominated loans include foreign exchange swaps and forward contracts.

The Bancorp also enters into derivative contracts (including foreign exchange contracts, commodity contracts and interest rate contracts) for the benefit of commercial customers and other business purposes. The Bancorp may economically hedge significant exposures related to these free-standing derivatives by entering into offsetting third-party contracts with approved, reputable counterparties with substantially matching terms and currencies. Credit risk arises from the possible inability of counterparties to meet the terms of their contracts. The Bancorp’s exposure is limited to the replacement value of the contracts rather than the notional, principal or contract amounts. Credit risk is minimized through credit approvals, limits, counterparty collateral and monitoring procedures.

The Bancorp’s derivative assets include certain contractual features in which the Bancorp requires the counterparties to provide collateral in the form of cash and securities to offset changes in the fair value of the derivatives, including changes in the fair value due to credit risk of the counterparty. As of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the balance of collateral held by the Bancorp for derivative assets was $528 million and $514 million, respectively. The credit component negatively impacting the fair value of derivative assets associated with customer accommodation contracts as of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013 was $10 million and $12 million, respectively.

In measuring the fair value of derivative liabilities, the Bancorp considers its own credit risk, taking into consideration collateral maintenance requirements of certain derivative counterparties and the duration of instruments with counterparties that do not require collateral maintenance. When necessary, the Bancorp posts collateral primarily in the form of cash and securities to offset changes in fair value of the derivatives, including changes in fair value due to the Bancorp’s credit risk. As of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the balance of collateral posted by the Bancorp for derivative liabilities was $543 million and $559 million, respectively. Certain of the Bancorp’s derivative liabilities contain credit-risk related contingent features that could result in the requirement to post additional collateral upon the occurrence of specified events. As of March 31, 2014, the fair value of the additional collateral that could be required to be posted as a result of the credit-risk related contingent features being triggered was immaterial to the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements. The posting of collateral has been determined to remove the need for further consideration of credit risk. As a result, the Bancorp determined that the impact of the Bancorp’s credit risk to the valuation of its derivative liabilities was immaterial to the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

The Bancorp holds certain derivative instruments that qualify for hedge accounting treatment and are designated as either fair value hedges or cash flow hedges. Derivative instruments that do not qualify for hedge accounting treatment, or for which hedge accounting is not established, are held as free-standing derivatives. All customer accommodation derivatives are held as free-standing derivatives.

The fair value of derivative instruments is presented on a gross basis, even when the derivative instruments are subject to master netting arrangements. Derivative instruments with a positive fair value are reported in other assets in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets while derivative instruments with a negative fair value are reported in other liabilities in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. Cash collateral payables and receivables associated with the derivative instruments are not added to or netted against the fair value amounts. For further information on offsetting derivatives, see Note 11 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

79


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

The following tables reflect the notional amounts and fair values for all derivative instruments included in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets as of:

 

            Fair Value  
     Notional      Derivative      Derivative  

March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

   Amount      Assets      Liabilities  

Qualifying hedging instruments

        

Fair value hedges:

        

Interest rate swaps related to long-term debt

   $ 3,205        325        11  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total fair value hedges

        325        11  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flow hedges:

        

Interest rate swaps related to C&I loans

     2,200        36        12  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total cash flow hedges

        36        12  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total derivatives designated as qualifying hedging instruments

        361        23  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Derivatives not designated as qualifying hedging instruments

        

Free-standing derivatives - risk management and other business purposes

        

Interest rate contracts related to MSRs

     5,277        151        9  

Forward contracts related to held for sale mortgage loans

     1,844        2        1  

Stock warrant associated with Vantiv Holding, LLC

     616        348        —    

Swap associated with the sale of Visa, Inc. Class B shares

     918        —          43  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total free-standing derivatives - risk management and other business purposes

        501        53  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Free-standing derivatives - customer accommodation:

        

Interest rate contracts for customers

     27,418        306        315  

Interest rate lock commitments

     994        16        —    

Commodity contracts

     3,179        66        68  

Foreign exchange contracts

     20,020        204        164  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total free-standing derivatives - customer accommodation

        592        547  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total derivatives not designated as qualifying hedging instruments

        1,093        600  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

      $ 1,454        623  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

            Fair Value  
     Notional      Derivative      Derivative  

December 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

   Amount      Assets      Liabilities  

Qualifying hedging instruments

        

Fair value hedges:

        

Interest rate swaps related to long-term debt

   $ 3,205        292        13  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total fair value hedges

        292        13  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flow hedges:

        

Interest rate swaps related to C&I loans

     2,200        40        21  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total cash flow hedges

        40        21  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total derivatives designated as qualifying hedging instruments

        332        34  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Derivatives not designated as qualifying hedging instruments

        

Free-standing derivatives - risk management and other business purposes

        

Interest rate contracts related to MSRs

     4,092        141        14  

Forward contracts related to held for sale mortgage loans

     1,448        13        1  

Stock warrant associated with Vantiv Holding, LLC

     664        384        —    

Swap associated with the sale of Visa, Inc. Class B shares

     947        —          48  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total free-standing derivatives - risk management and other business purposes

        538        63  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Free-standing derivatives - customer accommodation:

        

Interest rate contracts for customers

     28,112        329        339  

Interest rate lock commitments

     924        12        1  

Commodity contracts

     3,300        66        65  

Foreign exchange contracts

     19,688        276        252  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total free-standing derivatives - customer accommodation

        683        657  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total derivatives not designated as qualifying hedging instruments

        1,221        720  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

      $ 1,553        754  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

80


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

Fair Value Hedges

The Bancorp may enter into interest rate swaps to convert its fixed-rate funding to floating-rate. Decisions to convert fixed-rate funding to floating are made primarily through consideration of the asset/liability mix of the Bancorp, the desired asset/liability sensitivity and interest rate levels. As of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, certain interest rate swaps met the criteria required to qualify for the shortcut method of accounting. Based on this shortcut method of accounting treatment, no ineffectiveness is assumed. For interest rate swaps that do not meet the shortcut requirements, an assessment of hedge effectiveness using regression analysis was performed and such swaps were accounted for using the “long-haul” method. The long-haul method requires a quarterly assessment of hedge effectiveness and measurement of ineffectiveness. For interest rate swaps accounted for as a fair value hedge using the long-haul method, ineffectiveness is the difference between the changes in the fair value of the interest rate swap and changes in fair value of the related hedged item attributable to the risk being hedged. The ineffectiveness on interest rate swaps hedging fixed-rate funding is reported within interest expense in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income.

The following table reflects the change in fair value of interest rate contracts, designated as fair value hedges, as well as the change in fair value of the related hedged items attributable to the risk being hedged, included in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income:

 

    

Condensed Consolidated

Statements of Income Caption

   For the three months  
        ended March 31,  

($ in millions)

      2014     2013  

Interest rate contracts:

       

Change in fair value of interest rate swaps hedging long-term debt

   Interest on long-term debt    $ 35       (67

Change in fair value of hedged long-term debt

attributable to the risk being hedged

   Interest on long-term debt      (37     66  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash Flow Hedges

The Bancorp may enter into interest rate swaps to convert floating-rate assets and liabilities to fixed rates or to hedge certain forecasted transactions. The assets or liabilities may be grouped in circumstances where they share the same risk exposure for which the Bancorp desires to hedge. The Bancorp may also enter into interest rate caps and floors to limit cash flow variability of floating rate assets and liabilities. As of March 31, 2014, all hedges designated as cash flow hedges were assessed for effectiveness using regression analysis. Ineffectiveness is generally measured as the amount by which the cumulative change in the fair value of the hedging instrument exceeds the present value of the cumulative change in the hedged item’s expected cash flows attributable to the risk being hedged. Ineffectiveness is reported within other noninterest income in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income. The effective portion of the cumulative gains or losses on cash flow hedges are reported within accumulated other comprehensive income and are reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income to current period earnings when the forecasted transaction affects earnings. As of March 31, 2014, the maximum length of time over which the Bancorp is hedging its exposure to the variability in future cash flows is 69 months.

Reclassified gains and losses on interest rate contracts related to commercial and industrial loans are recorded within interest income while reclassified gains and losses on interest rate contracts related to long-term debt are recorded within interest expense in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income. As of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $16 million and $13 million, respectively, of deferred gains, net of tax, on cash flow hedges were recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. As of March 31, 2014, approximately $26 million of net deferred gains, net of tax, recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income are expected to be reclassified into earnings during the next twelve months. This amount could differ from amounts actually recognized due to changes in interest rates, hedge de-designations, and the addition of other hedges subsequent to March 31, 2014.

During the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, there were no gains or losses reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income into earnings associated with the discontinuance of cash flow hedges because it was probable that the original forecasted transaction would not occur by the end of the originally specified time period or within the additional period of time as defined by U.S. GAAP.

The following table presents the net gains recorded in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income and in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income relating to derivative instruments designated as cash flow hedges:

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014      2013  

Amount of net gain recognized in OCI

   $ 15        1  

Amount of net gain reclassified from OCI into net income

     10        21  

Free-Standing Derivative Instruments – Risk Management and Other Business Purposes

As part of its overall risk management strategy relative to its mortgage banking activity, the Bancorp may enter into various free-standing derivatives (principal-only swaps, interest rate swaptions, interest rate floors, mortgage options, TBAs and interest rate swaps) to economically hedge changes in fair value of its largely fixed-rate MSR portfolio. Principal-only swaps hedge the mortgage-LIBOR spread because these swaps appreciate in value as a result of tightening spreads. Principal-only swaps also provide prepayment protection by increasing in value when prepayment speeds increase, as opposed to MSRs that lose value in a faster prepayment environment. Receive fixed/pay floating interest rate swaps and swaptions increase in value when interest rates do not increase as quickly as expected.

 

81


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

The Bancorp enters into forward contracts and mortgage options to economically hedge the change in fair value of certain residential mortgage loans held for sale due to changes in interest rates. Interest rate lock commitments issued on residential mortgage loan commitments that will be held for sale are also considered free-standing derivative instruments and the interest rate exposure on these commitments is economically hedged primarily with forward contracts. Revaluation gains and losses from free-standing derivatives related to mortgage banking activity are recorded as a component of mortgage banking net revenue in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income.

Additionally, as part of the Bancorp’s overall risk management strategy with respect to minimizing significant fluctuations in earnings and cash flows caused by interest rate and prepayment volatility, the Bancorp may enter into free-standing derivative instruments (options, swaptions and interest rate swaps). The gains and losses on these derivative contracts are recorded within other noninterest income in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income.

In conjunction with the initial sale of the Bancorp’s 51% interest in Vantiv Holding, LLC, the Bancorp received a warrant which is accounted for as a free-standing derivative. Refer to Note 19 for further discussion of significant inputs and assumptions used in the valuation of the warrant.

In conjunction with the sale of Visa, Inc. Class B shares in 2009, the Bancorp entered into a total return swap in which the Bancorp will make or receive payments based on subsequent changes in the conversion rate of the Class B shares into Class A shares. This total return swap is accounted for as a free-standing derivative. See Note 19 for further discussion of significant inputs and assumptions used in the valuation of this instrument.

The net gains (losses) recorded in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income relating to free-standing derivative instruments used for risk management and other business purposes are summarized in the following table:

 

    

Condensed Consolidated

Statements of

   For the three
months
ended
March 31,
 

($ in millions)

  

Income Caption

   2014     2013  

Interest rate contracts:

       

Forward contracts related to mortgage loans held for sale

   Mortgage banking net revenue    $ (12     (3

Interest rate contracts related to MSR portfolio

   Mortgage banking net revenue      24       (6

Foreign exchange contracts:

       

Foreign exchange contracts for risk management purposes

   Other noninterest income      4       2  

Equity contracts:

       

Stock warrant associated with Vantiv Holding, LLC

   Other noninterest income      (36     34  

Swap associated with sale of Visa, Inc. Class B shares

   Other noninterest income      1       (7
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Free-Standing Derivative Instruments – Customer Accommodation

The majority of the free-standing derivative instruments the Bancorp enters into are for the benefit of its commercial customers. These derivative contracts are not designated against specific assets or liabilities on the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets or to forecasted transactions and, therefore, do not qualify for hedge accounting. These instruments include foreign exchange derivative contracts entered into for the benefit of commercial customers involved in international trade to hedge their exposure to foreign currency fluctuations and commodity contracts to hedge such items as natural gas and various other derivative contracts. The Bancorp may economically hedge significant exposures related to these derivative contracts entered into for the benefit of customers by entering into offsetting contracts with approved, reputable, independent counterparties with substantially matching terms. The Bancorp hedges its interest rate exposure on commercial customer transactions by executing offsetting swap agreements with primary dealers. Revaluation gains and losses on interest rate, foreign exchange, commodity and other commercial customer derivative contracts are recorded as a component of corporate banking revenue in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income.

The Bancorp enters into risk participation agreements, under which the Bancorp assumes credit exposure relating to certain underlying interest rate derivative contracts. The Bancorp only enters into these risk participation agreements in instances in which the Bancorp has participated in the loan that the underlying interest rate derivative contract was designed to hedge. The Bancorp will make payments under these agreements if a customer defaults on its obligation to perform under the terms of the underlying interest rate derivative contract. As of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the total notional amount of the risk participation agreements was $1.2 billion, and the fair value was a liability of $3 million at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, which is included in interest rate contracts for customers. As of March 31, 2014, the risk participation agreements had an average remaining life of 2.9 years.

The Bancorp’s maximum exposure in the risk participation agreements is contingent on the fair value of the underlying interest rate derivative contracts in an asset position at the time of default. The Bancorp monitors the credit risk associated with the underlying customers in the risk participation agreements through the same risk grading system currently utilized for establishing loss reserves in its loan and lease portfolio.

 

82


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

Risk ratings of the notional amount of risk participation agreements under this risk rating system are summarized in the following table:

 

     March 31,      December 31,  

As of ($ in millions)

   2014      2013  

Pass

   $ 1,118        1,153  

Special mention

     2        38  

Substandard

     50        12  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,170        1,203  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The net gains (losses) recorded in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income relating to free-standing derivative instruments used for customer accommodation are summarized in the following table:

 

   

Condensed Consolidated

Statements of Income Caption

  For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

    2014     2013  

Interest rate contracts:

     

Interest rate contracts for customers (contract revenue)

  Corporate banking revenue   $ 4       5  

Interest rate contracts for customers (credit losses)

  Other noninterest expense     —         (1

Interest rate contracts for customers (credit portion of fair value adjustment)

  Other noninterest expense     1       1  

Interest rate lock commitments

  Mortgage banking net revenue     36       56  

Commodity contracts:

     

Commodity contracts for customers (contract revenue)

  Corporate banking revenue     1       2  

Foreign exchange contracts:

     

Foreign exchange contracts - customers (contract revenue)

  Corporate banking revenue     15       18  

Foreign exchange contracts - customers (credit portion of fair value adjustment)

  Other noninterest expense     2       —    
   

 

 

   

 

 

 

11. Offsetting Derivative Financial Instruments

The Bancorp’s derivative transactions are generally governed by ISDA Master Agreements and similar arrangements, which include provisions governing the setoff of assets and liabilities between the parties. When the Bancorp has more than one outstanding derivative transaction with a single counterparty, the setoff provisions contained within these agreements generally allow the non-defaulting party the right to reduce its liability to the defaulting party by amounts eligible for setoff, including the collateral received as well as eligible offsetting transactions with that counterparty, irrespective of the currency, place of payment, or booking office. The Bancorp’s policy is to present its derivative assets and derivative liabilities on the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets on a gross basis, even when provisions allowing for setoff are in place.

Collateral amounts included in the table below consist primarily of cash and highly-rated government-backed securities.

 

     Gross Amount
Recognized  in the
Condensed Consolidated
Balance Sheet
(a)
     Gross Amounts Not Offset in the        
        Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheet        

March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

      Derivatives     Collateral(b)     Net Amount  

Assets

         

Derivatives

   $ 1,090        (236     (443   $ 411  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

     1,090        (236     (443     411  

Liabilities

         

Derivatives

     623        (236     (291     96  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

   $ 623        (236     (291   $ 96  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     Gross Amount
Recognized in the
Condensed Consolidated
Balance Sheet
(a)
     Gross Amounts Not Offset in the        
        Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheet        

December 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

      Derivatives     Collateral(b)     Net Amount  

Assets

         

Derivatives

   $ 1,157        (321     (390   $ 446  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

     1,157        (321     (390     446  

Liabilities

         

Derivatives

     753        (321     (302     130  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

   $ 753        (321     (302   $ 130  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Amount does not include the stock warrant associated with Vantiv Holding, LLC and IRLCs because these instruments are not subject to master netting or similar arrangements.
(b) Amount of collateral received as an offset to asset positions or pledged as an offset to liability positions. Collateral values in excess of related derivative amounts recognized in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets were excluded from this table.

 

83


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

12. Long-Term Debt

On February 28, 2014, the Bancorp issued and sold $500 million of 2.30% unsecured senior fixed rate notes, with a maturity of five years, due on March 1, 2019. These notes will be redeemable by the Bancorp, in whole or in part, on or after the date that is 30 days prior to the maturity date at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount plus accrued and unpaid interest up to, but excluding, the redemption date.

As previously discussed in Note 8, a consolidated VIE of the Bancorp issued $1.3 billion of asset-backed securities related to an automobile loan securitization in the first quarter of 2014. Third-party holders of the debt associated with this transaction do not have recourse to the general assets of the Bancorp.

For further information on subsequent events related to long-term debt refer to Note 21.

13. Capital Actions

On March 18, 2014, the Bancorp’s Board of Directors authorized the Bancorp to repurchase up to 100 million shares of its outstanding common stock in the open market or in privately negotiated transactions, and to utilize any derivative or similar instrument to effect share repurchase transactions (including without limitation, accelerated share repurchase contracts, equity forward transactions, equity option transactions, equity swap transactions, cap transactions, collar transactions, floor transactions or other similar transactions or any combination of the foregoing transactions). This share repurchase authorization replaced the Board’s previous authorization from March of 2013.

During 2013 and the three months ended March 31, 2014, the Bancorp entered into a number of accelerated share repurchase transactions. As part of these transactions, the Bancorp entered into forward contracts in which the final number of shares delivered at settlement was based generally on a discount to the average daily volume weighted average price of the Bancorp’s common stock during the term of these repurchase agreements. The accelerated share repurchases were treated as two separate transactions (i) the acquisition of treasury shares on the acquisition date and (ii) a forward contract indexed to the Bancorp’s stock.

For further information on subsequent events related to capital actions refer to Note 21.

The following table presents a summary of the Bancorp’s accelerated share repurchase transactions that were entered into or settled during the three months ended March 31, 2014:

 

Repurchase Date

   Amount
($ in millions)
     Shares
Repurchased
     Shares Received
from Forward
Contract Settlement
     Total Shares
Repurchased
     Settlement Date  

November 18, 2013

   $ 200        8,538,423        1,132,495        9,670,918        March 5, 2014   

December 13, 2013

     456        19,084,195        2,294,932        21,379,127        March 31, 2014   

January 31, 2014

     99        3,950,705        602,109        4,552,814        March 31, 2014   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

84


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

14. Commitments, Contingent Liabilities and Guarantees

The Bancorp, in the normal course of business, enters into financial instruments and various agreements to meet the financing needs of its customers. The Bancorp also enters into certain transactions and agreements to manage its interest rate and prepayment risks, provide funding, equipment and locations for its operations and invest in its communities. These instruments and agreements involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk, counterparty risk and market risk in excess of the amounts recognized in the Bancorp’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. The creditworthiness of counterparties for all instruments and agreements is evaluated on a case-by-case basis in accordance with the Bancorp’s credit policies. The Bancorp’s significant commitments, contingent liabilities and guarantees in excess of the amounts recognized in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets are discussed in further detail below:

Commitments

The Bancorp has certain commitments to make future payments under contracts. The following table reflects a summary of significant commitments as of:

 

     March 31,      December 31,  

($ in millions)

   2014      2013  

Commitments to extend credit

   $ 63,021        62,050  

Letters of credit

     4,194        4,129  

Forward contracts to sell mortgage loans

     1,844        1,448  

Noncancelable lease obligations

     729        746  

Capital commitments for private equity investments

     95        90  

Purchase obligations

     80        84  

Capital expenditures

     29        33  

Capital lease obligations

     17        19  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commitments to extend credit

Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend, typically having fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses that may require payment of a fee. Since many of the commitments to extend credit may expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash flow requirements. The Bancorp is exposed to credit risk in the event of nonperformance by the counterparty for the amount of the contract. Fixed-rate commitments are also subject to market risk resulting from fluctuations in interest rates and the Bancorp’s exposure is limited to the replacement value of those commitments. As of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the Bancorp had a reserve for unfunded commitments, including letters of credit, totaling $153 million and $162 million, respectively, included in other liabilities in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. The Bancorp monitors the credit risk associated with commitments to extend credit using the same risk rating system utilized within its loan and lease portfolio.

Risk ratings under this risk rating system are summarized in the following table as of:

 

($ in millions)

   March 31,
2014
     December 31,
2013
 

Pass

   $ 62,301        61,364  

Special mention

     382        369  

Substandard

     338        316  

Doubtful

     —          1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 63,021        62,050  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Letters of credit

Standby and commercial letters of credit are conditional commitments issued to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party and expire as summarized in the following table as of:

 

($ in millions)

   March 31,
2014
 

Less than 1 year(a)

   $ 1,849  

1 - 5 years(a)

     2,302  

Over 5 years

     43  
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 4,194  
  

 

 

 

 

(a) Includes $69 and $3 issued on behalf of commercial customers to facilitate trade payments in U.S. dollars and foreign currencies which expire less than one year and between one and five years, respectively.

Standby letters of credit accounted for 98% of total letters of credit at March 31, 2014 compared to 97% at December 31, 2013 and are considered guarantees in accordance with U.S. GAAP. Approximately 48% of the total standby letters of credit were fully secured as of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. In the event of nonperformance by the customers, the Bancorp has rights to the underlying collateral, which can include commercial real estate, physical plant and property, inventory, receivables, cash and marketable securities. The reserve related to these standby letters of credit, which was included in the total reserve for unfunded commitments, was $2 million at both March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013. The Bancorp monitors the credit risk associated with letters of credit using the same risk rating system utilized within its loan and lease portfolio.

 

85


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

Risk ratings under this risk rating system are summarized in the following table as of:

 

     March 31,      December 31,  

($ in millions)

   2014      2013  

Pass

   $ 3,755        3,651  

Special mention

     109        99  

Substandard

     301        355  

Doubtful

     29        24  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 4,194        4,129  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

At March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the Bancorp had outstanding letters of credit that were supporting certain securities issued as VRDNs. The Bancorp facilitates financing for its commercial customers, which consist of companies and municipalities, by marketing the VRDNs to investors. The VRDNs pay interest to holders at a rate of interest that fluctuates based upon market demand. The VRDNs generally have long-term maturity dates, but can be tendered by the holder for purchase at par value upon proper advance notice. When the VRDNs are tendered, a remarketing agent generally finds another investor to purchase the VRDNs to keep the securities outstanding in the market. As of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, total VRDNs in which the Bancorp was the remarketing agent or were supported by a Bancorp letter of credit were $2.0 billion and $2.1 billion of which FTS acted as the remarketing agent to issuers on $1.7 billion and $1.8 billion, respectively. As remarketing agent, FTS is responsible for finding purchasers for VRDNs that are put by investors. The Bancorp issued letters of credit, as a credit enhancement, on $1.4 billion and $1.5 billion to the VRDNs remarketed by FTS, in addition to $277 million and $300 million in VRDNs remarketed by third parties at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. These letters of credit are included in the total letters of credit balance provided in the previous table.

Forward contracts to sell mortgage loans

The Bancorp enters into forward contracts to economically hedge the change in fair value of certain residential mortgage loans held for sale due to changes in interest rates. The outstanding notional amounts of these forward contracts are included in the summary of significant commitments table above for all periods presented.

Noncancelable lease obligations and other commitments

The Bancorp’s subsidiaries have entered into a number of noncancelable lease agreements. The minimum rental commitments under noncancelable lease agreements are shown in the summary of significant commitments table. The Bancorp has also entered into a limited number of agreements for work related to banking center construction and to purchase goods or services.

Contingent Liabilities

Private mortgage reinsurance

For certain mortgage loans originated by the Bancorp, borrowers may be required to obtain PMI provided by third-party insurers. In some instances, these insurers cede a portion of the PMI premiums to the Bancorp, and the Bancorp provides reinsurance coverage within a specified range of the total PMI coverage. The Bancorp’s reinsurance coverage typically ranges from 5% to 10% of the total PMI coverage. The Bancorp’s maximum exposure in the event of nonperformance by the underlying borrowers is equivalent to the Bancorp’s total outstanding reinsurance coverage, which was $33 million at March 31, 2014 and $37 million at December 31, 2013. As of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the Bancorp maintained a reserve of $7 million and $10 million, respectively, related to exposures within the reinsurance portfolio which was included in other liabilities in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. During 2009, the Bancorp suspended the practice of providing reinsurance of private mortgage insurance for newly originated mortgage loans.

Legal claims

There are legal claims pending against the Bancorp and its subsidiaries that have arisen in the normal course of business. See Note 15 for additional information regarding these proceedings.

Guarantees

The Bancorp has performance obligations upon the occurrence of certain events under financial guarantees provided in certain contractual arrangements as discussed in the following sections.

Residential mortgage loans sold with representation and warranty provisions

Conforming residential mortgage loans sold to unrelated third parties are generally sold with representation and warranty provisions. A contractual liability arises only in the event of a breach of these representations and warranties and, in general, only when a loss results from the breach. The Bancorp may be required to repurchase any previously sold loan or indemnify (make whole) the investor or insurer for which the representation or warranty of the Bancorp proves to be inaccurate, incomplete or misleading.

The Bancorp establishes a residential mortgage repurchase reserve related to various representations and warranties that reflects management’s estimate of losses based on a combination of factors. The Bancorp’s estimation process requires management to make subjective and complex judgments about matters that are inherently uncertain, such as, future demand expectations, economic factors and the specific characteristics of the loans subject to repurchase. Such factors incorporate historical investor audit and repurchase demand rates, appeals success rates, historical loss severity, and any additional information obtained from the GSEs regarding future mortgage repurchase and file request criteria. At the time of a loan sale, the Bancorp records a representation and warranty reserve at the estimated fair value of the Bancorp’s guarantee and continually updates the reserve during the life of the loan as losses in excess of the reserve become probable and reasonably estimable. The provision for the estimated fair value of the representation and warranty guarantee arising from the loan sales is recorded as an adjustment to the gain on sale, which is included in noninterest income at the time of sale. Updates to the reserve are recorded in other noninterest expense.

 

86


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

During the fourth quarter of 2013, the Bancorp settled certain repurchase claims related to mortgage loans originated and sold to FHLMC prior to January 1, 2009 for $25 million, after paid claim credits and other adjustments. The settlement removes the Bancorp’s responsibility to repurchase or indemnify FHLMC for representation and warranty violations on any loan sold prior to January 1, 2009 except in limited circumstances.

The Bancorp maintained reserves related to these loans sold with representation and warranty provisions, which were included in other liabilities on the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets, totaling $38 million and $44 million as of March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.

The Bancorp uses the best information available to it in estimating its mortgage representation and warranty reserve; however, the estimation process is inherently uncertain and imprecise and, accordingly, losses in excess of the amounts reserved as of March 31, 2014, are reasonably possible. The Bancorp currently estimates that it is reasonably possible that it could incur losses related to mortgage representation and warranty provisions in an amount up to approximately $50 million in excess of amounts reserved. This estimate was derived by modifying the key assumptions discussed above to reflect management’s judgment regarding reasonably possible adverse changes to those assumptions. The actual repurchase losses could vary significantly from the recorded mortgage representation and warranty reserve or this estimate of reasonably possibly losses, depending on the outcome of various factors, including those noted above.

For the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, the Bancorp paid $7 million and $13 million, respectively, in the form of make whole payments and repurchased $23 million and $30 million, respectively, in outstanding principal of loans to satisfy investor demands. Total repurchase demand requests during the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013 were $35 million and $67 million, respectively. Total outstanding repurchase demand inventory was $21 million at March 31, 2014 compared to $46 million at December 31, 2013.

The following table summarizes activity in the reserve for representation and warranty provisions:

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Balance, beginning of period

   $ 44       110  

Net additions to the reserve

     2       19  

Losses charged against the reserve

     (8     (17
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

   $ 38       112  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table provides a rollforward of unresolved demands by claimant type for the three months ended March 31, 2014:

 

     GSE     Private Label  

($ in millions)

   Units     Dollars     Units     Dollars  

Balance, beginning of period

     264     $ 41       33     $ 5  

New demands

     230       34       10       1  

Loan paydowns/payoffs

     (16     (1     (2     (1

Resolved demands

     (375     (55     (31     (3
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

     103     $ 19       10     $ 2  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table provides a rollforward of unresolved demands by claimant type for the three months ended March 31, 2013:

 

     GSE     Private Label  

($ in millions)

   Units     Dollars     Units     Dollars  

Balance, beginning of period

     294     $ 48       124     $ 19  

New demands

     458       66       76       1  

Loan paydowns/payoffs

     (5     (1     (4     (1

Resolved demands

     (484     (71     (163     (14
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

     263     $ 42       33     $ 5  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Residential mortgage loans sold with credit recourse

The Bancorp sold certain residential mortgage loans in the secondary market with credit recourse. In the event of any customer default, pursuant to the credit recourse provided, the Bancorp is required to reimburse the third party. The maximum amount of credit risk in the event of nonperformance by the underlying borrowers is equivalent to the total outstanding balance. In the event of nonperformance, the Bancorp has rights to the underlying collateral value securing the loan. The outstanding balances on these loans sold with credit recourse were $563 million and $579 million at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, and the delinquency rates were 3.6% and 4.4% at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. The Bancorp maintained an estimated credit loss reserve on these loans sold with credit recourse of $15 million and $16 million at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, recorded in other liabilities in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. To determine the credit loss reserve, the Bancorp used an approach that is consistent with its overall approach in estimating credit losses for various categories of residential mortgage loans held in its loan portfolio.

 

87


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

Margin accounts

FTS, a subsidiary of the Bancorp, guarantees the collection of all margin account balances held by its brokerage clearing agent for the benefit of its customers. FTS is responsible for payment to its brokerage clearing agent for any loss, liability, damage, cost or expense incurred as a result of customers failing to comply with margin or margin maintenance calls on all margin accounts. The margin account balance held by the brokerage clearing agent was $16 million and $12 million at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. In the event of any customer default, FTS has rights to the underlying collateral provided. Given the existence of the underlying collateral provided and negligible historical credit losses, the Bancorp does not maintain a loss reserve related to the margin accounts.

Long-term borrowing obligations

The Bancorp had certain fully and unconditionally guaranteed long-term borrowing obligations issued by wholly-owned issuing trust entities of $62 million at March 31, 2014.

Visa litigation

The Bancorp, as a member bank of Visa prior to Visa’s reorganization and IPO (the “IPO”) of its Class A common shares in 2008, had certain indemnification obligations pursuant to Visa’s certificate of incorporation and by-laws and in accordance with their membership agreements. In accordance with Visa’s by-laws prior to the IPO, the Bancorp could have been required to indemnify Visa for the Bancorp’s proportional share of losses based on the pre-IPO membership interests. As part of its reorganization and IPO, the Bancorp’s indemnification obligation was modified to include only certain known litigation (the “Covered Litigation”) as of the date of the restructuring. This modification triggered a requirement for the Bancorp to recognize a liability equal to the fair value of the indemnification liability.

In conjunction with the IPO, the Bancorp received 10.1 million of Visa’s Class B shares based on the Bancorp’s membership percentage in Visa prior to the IPO. The Class B shares are not transferable (other than to another member bank) until the later of the third anniversary of the IPO closing or the date which the Covered Litigation has been resolved; therefore, the Bancorp’s Class B shares were classified in other assets and accounted for at their carryover basis of $0. Visa deposited $3 billion of the proceeds from the IPO into a litigation escrow account, established for the purpose of funding judgments in, or settlements of, the Covered Litigation. If Visa’s litigation committee determines that the escrow account is insufficient, then Visa will issue additional Class A shares and deposit the proceeds from the sale of the shares into the litigation escrow account. When Visa funds the litigation escrow account, the Class B shares are subject to dilution through an adjustment in the conversion rate of Class B shares into Class A shares.

In 2009, the Bancorp completed the sale of Visa, Inc. Class B shares and entered into a total return swap in which the Bancorp will make or receive payments based on subsequent changes in the conversion rate of the Class B shares into Class A shares. The swap terminates on the later of the third anniversary of Visa’s IPO or the date on which the Covered Litigation is settled. See Note 19 for additional information on the valuation of the swap. The counterparty to the swap as a result of its ownership of the Class B shares will be impacted by dilutive adjustments to the conversion rate of the Class B shares into Class A shares caused by any Covered Litigation losses in excess of the litigation escrow account. If actual judgments in, or settlements of, the Covered Litigation significantly exceed current expectations, then additional funding by Visa of the litigation escrow account and the resulting dilution of the Class B shares could result in a scenario where the Bancorp’s ultimate exposure associated with the Covered Litigation (the “Visa Litigation Exposure”) exceeds the value of the Class B shares owned by the swap counterparty (the “Class B Value”). In the event the Bancorp concludes that it is probable that the Visa Litigation Exposure exceeds the Class B Value, the Bancorp would record a litigation reserve liability and a corresponding amount of other noninterest expense for the amount of the excess. Any such litigation reserve liability would be separate and distinct from the fair value derivative liability associated with the total return swap.

As of the date of the Bancorp’s sale of Visa Class B shares and through March 31, 2014, the Bancorp has concluded that it is not probable that the Visa Litigation Exposure will exceed the Class B value. Based on this determination, upon the sale of Class B shares, the Bancorp reversed its net Visa litigation reserve liability and recognized a free-standing derivative liability associated with the total return swap. The fair value of the swap liability was $43 million and $48 million at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. Refer to Note 15 for further information.

After the Bancorp’s sale of Visa Class B shares, Visa has funded additional amounts into the litigation escrow account which have resulted in further dilution in the conversion of Class B shares into Class A shares, and along with other terms of the total return swap, required the Bancorp to make cash payments to the swap counterparty as follows:

 

($ in millions)

             

Period

   Visa
Funding Amount
     Bancorp Cash
Payment Amount
 

Q2 2010

   $ 500      $ 20  

Q4 2010

     800        35  

Q2 2011

     400        19  

Q1 2012

     1,565        75  

Q3 2012

     150        6  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

88


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

15. Legal and Regulatory Proceedings

During April 2006, the Bancorp was added as a defendant in a consolidated antitrust class action lawsuit originally filed against Visa®, MasterCard® and several other major financial institutions in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of New York. The plaintiffs, merchants operating commercial businesses throughout the U.S. and trade associations, claimed that the interchange fees charged by card-issuing banks were unreasonable and sought injunctive relief and unspecified damages. In addition to being a named defendant, the Bancorp is also subject to a possible indemnification obligation of Visa as discussed in Note 14 and has also entered into judgment and loss sharing agreements with Visa, MasterCard and certain other named defendants. In October 2012, the parties to the litigation entered into a settlement agreement. The court entered a Class Settlement Preliminary Approval Order in November 2012. Pursuant to the terms of the settlement agreement, the Bancorp paid $46 million into a class settlement escrow account. Previously, the Bancorp paid an additional $4 million in another settlement escrow in connection with the settlement of claims from plaintiffs not included in the class action. More than 7,900 merchants have requested exclusion from the class settlement. Pursuant to the terms of the settlement agreement, 25% of the funds paid into the class settlement escrow account have been returned to the control of the defendants through Class Exclusion Takedown Payments. Approximately 460 of the merchants who requested exclusion from the class have filed separate federal lawsuits against Visa, MasterCard and certain other defendants alleging similar antitrust violations. The federal lawsuits have been transferred to the United States District Court for the Eastern District of New York. The Bancorp was not named as a defendant in any of the federal lawsuits, but may have obligations pursuant to indemnification arrangements and/or the judgment or loss sharing agreements noted above. In addition, one merchant filed a separate state court lawsuit against Visa, MasterCard and certain other defendants, including the Bancorp, alleging similar antitrust violations. On January 14, 2014, the court entered a final order approving the class settlement. A number of merchants have filed appeals from that approval. Refer to Note 14 for further information.

In 2008, two cases were filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of Ohio against the Bancorp and certain officers styled Dudenhoeffer v Fifth Third Bancorp et al. Case No. 1:08-cv-538. The complaints alleged violations of ERISA based on allegations similar to those set forth in the previously reported securities class action cases. The ERISA actions were dismissed by the trial court, but the Sixth Circuit Court of Appeals reversed the trial court decision. The Bancorp petitioned the United States Supreme Court to review and reverse the Sixth Circuit decision and sought a stay of proceedings in the trial court pending appeal. On March 25, 2013 the Supreme Court issued an order directing the Solicitor General to file a brief stating the views of the United States on the issues raised in the Bancorp petition and this brief was filed on November 12, 2013. On December 13, 2013 the Supreme Court granted certiorari and agreed to hear the appeal. Oral argument was held on April 2, 2014 and a decision is expected in June of 2014.

The Bancorp and its subsidiaries are not parties to any other material litigation. However, there are other litigation matters that arise in the normal course of business. While it is impossible to ascertain the ultimate resolution or range of financial liability with respect to these contingent matters, management believes any resulting liability from these other actions would not have a material effect upon the Bancorp’s consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

The Bancorp and/or its affiliates are involved in information-gathering requests, reviews, investigations and proceedings (both formal and informal) by various governmental regulatory agencies and law enforcement authorities, as well as self-regulatory bodies regarding their respective businesses. Additional matters will likely arise from time to time. Any of these matters may result in material adverse consequences to the Bancorp, its affiliates and/or their respective directors, officers and other personnel, including adverse judgments, findings, settlements, fines, penalties, orders, injunctions or other actions, amendments and/or restatements of the Bancorp’s SEC filings and/or financial statements, as applicable, and/or determinations of material weaknesses in our disclosure controls and procedures. Investigations by regulatory authorities may from time to time result in civil or criminal referrals to law enforcement authorities such as the Department of Justice or a United States Attorney. Among other matters, the Bancorp has been cooperating with the Department of Justice and the Office of the Inspector General for the Department of Housing and Urban Development in a civil investigation regarding compliance with requirements relating to certain Federal Housing Agency-insured loans originated by affiliates of the Bancorp. The investigation could lead to a demand under the federal False Claims Act and the federal Financial Institutions Reform, Recovery and Enforcement Act of 1989, which allow up to treble and other special damages substantially in excess of actual losses. Additionally, the Bancorp is also cooperating with an investigation by the Department of Justice to determine whether the Bank engaged in any discriminatory practices in connection with the Bank’s indirect automobile loan portfolio. Any claim resulting from this investigation could include direct and indirect damages and civil money penalties.

The Bancorp is party to numerous claims and lawsuits as well as threatened or potential actions or claims concerning matters arising from the conduct of its business activities. The outcome of claims or litigation and the timing of ultimate resolution are inherently difficult to predict. The following factors, among others, contribute to this lack of predictability: plaintiff claims often include significant legal uncertainties, damages alleged by plaintiffs are often unspecified or overstated, discovery may not have started or may not be complete and material facts may be disputed or unsubstantiated. As a result of these factors, the Bancorp is not always able to provide an estimate of the range of reasonably possible outcomes for each claim. A reserve for a potential litigation loss is established when information related to the loss contingency indicates both that a loss is probable and that the amount of loss can be reasonably estimated. Any such reserve is adjusted from time to time thereafter as appropriate to reflect changes in circumstances. The Bancorp also determines, when possible (due to the uncertainties described above), estimates of reasonably possible losses or ranges of reasonably possible losses, in excess of amounts reserved. Under U.S. GAAP, an event is “reasonably possible” if “the chance of the future event or events occurring is more than remote but less than likely” and an event is “remote” if “the chance of the future event or events occurring is slight.” Thus, references to the upper end of the range of reasonably possible loss for cases in which the Bancorp is able to estimate a range of reasonably possible loss mean the upper end of the range of loss for cases for which the Bancorp believes the risk of loss is more than slight. For matters where the Bancorp is able to estimate such possible losses or ranges of possible losses, the Bancorp currently estimates that it is reasonably possible that it could incur losses related to legal proceedings including the matters discussed above in an aggregate amount up to approximately $117 million in excess of amounts reserved, with it also being reasonably possible that no losses will be incurred in these matters. The estimates included in this amount are based on the Bancorp’s analysis of currently available information, and as new information is obtained the Bancorp may change its estimates.

 

89


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

For these matters and others where an unfavorable outcome is reasonably possible but not probable, there may be a range of possible losses in excess of the established reserve that cannot be estimated. Based on information currently available, advice of counsel, available insurance coverage and established reserves, the Bancorp believes that the eventual outcome of the actions against the Bancorp and/or its subsidiaries, including the matters described above, will not, individually or in the aggregate, have a material adverse effect on the Bancorp’s consolidated financial position. However, in the event of unexpected future developments, it is possible that the ultimate resolution of those matters, if unfavorable, may be material to the Bancorp’s results of operations for any particular period, depending, in part, upon the size of the loss or liability imposed and the operating results for the applicable period.

16. Income Taxes

The Bancorp’s provision for income taxes was $119 million and $179 million for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The effective tax rates for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013 were 27.3% and 30.4%, respectively. The decrease in the effective tax rate for the three months ended March 31, 2014 compared to the same period in the prior year was primarily due to a non-cash charge recorded in 2013 related to previously recognized tax benefits associated with stock-based awards that were not realized.

While it is reasonably possible that the amount of the unrecognized tax benefits with respect to certain of the Bancorp’s uncertain tax positions could increase or decrease during the next 12 months, the Bancorp believes it is unlikely that its unrecognized tax benefits will change by a material amount during the next 12 months.

 

90


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

17. Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income

The activity of the components of other comprehensive income and accumulated other comprehensive income for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013 was as follows:

 

     Total Other     Total Accumulated Other  
     Comprehensive Income     Comprehensive Income  
     Pretax     Tax     Net     Beginning     Net     Ending  

($ in millions)

   Activity     Effect     Activity     Balance     Activity     Balance  

March 31, 2014

            

Unrealized holding gains on available-for-sale securities arising during period

   $ 173       (60     113        

Reclassification adjustment for net gains included in net income

     (5     2       (3      
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Net unrealized gains on available-for-sale securities

     168       (58     110       121       110       231  

Unrealized holding gains on cash flow hedge derivatives arising during period

     15       (5     10        

Reclassification adjustment for net gains on cash flow hedge derivatives included in net income

     (10     3       (7      
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Net unrealized gains on cash flow hedge derivatives

     5       (2     3       13       3       16  

Reclassification of amounts to net periodic benefit costs

     2       (1     1        
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Defined benefit plans, net

     2       (1     1       (52     1       (51
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 175       (61     114       82       114       196  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     Total Other     Total Accumulated Other  
     Comprehensive Income     Comprehensive Income  
     Pretax     Tax     Net     Beginning     Net     Ending  

($ in millions)

   Activity     Effect     Activity     Balance     Activity     Balance  

March 31, 2013

            

Unrealized holding losses on available-for-sale securities arising during period

   $ (56     20       (36      

Reclassification adjustment for net losses included in net income

     7       (2     5        
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Net unrealized gains on available-for-sale securities

     (49     18       (31     412       (31     381  

Unrealized holding gains on cash flow hedge derivatives arising during period

     1       —         1        

Reclassification adjustment for net gains on cash flow hedge derivatives included in net income

     (21     7       (14      
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Net unrealized gains on cash flow hedge derivatives

     (20     7       (13     50       (13     37  

Reclassification of amounts to net periodic benefit costs

     3       (1     2        
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Defined benefit plans, net

     3       (1     2       (87     2       (85
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ (66     24       (42     375       (42     333  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

91


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

The table below presents reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income for the three months ended March 31, 2014:

 

Components of AOCI: ($ in millions)

   Amount Reclassified
from AOCI(b)
   

Affected Line Item in the Condensed

Consolidated Statements of Income

Net unrealized gains on available-for-sale securities

    

Net gains included in net income

   $ 5     Securities gains, net
  

 

 

   
     5     Income before income taxes
     (2   Applicable income tax expense
  

 

 

   
     3     Net income
  

 

 

   

Net unrealized gains on cash flow hedge derivatives

    

Interest rate contracts related to C&I loans

     10     Interest and fees on loans and leases
  

 

 

   
     10     Income before income taxes
     (3   Applicable income tax expense
  

 

 

   
     7     Net income
  

 

 

   

Net periodic benefit costs

    

Amortization of net actuarial loss

     (2   Employee benefits expense (a)
  

 

 

   
     (2   Income before income taxes
     1     Applicable income tax expense
  

 

 

   
     (1   Net income
  

 

 

   

Total reclassifications for the period

   $ 9     Net income
  

 

 

   

The table below presents reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income for the three months ended March 31, 2013:

 

Components of AOCI: ($ in millions)

   Amount Reclassified
from AOCI(b)
   

Affected Line Item in the Condensed

Consolidated Statements of Income

Net unrealized gains on available-for-sale securities

    

Net losses included in net income

   $ (7   Securities gains, net
  

 

 

   
     (7   Income before income taxes
     2     Applicable income tax expense
  

 

 

   
     (5   Net income
  

 

 

   

Net unrealized gains on cash flow hedge derivatives

    

Interest rate contracts related to C&I loans

     22     Interest and fees on loans and leases

Interest rate contracts related to long-term debt

     (1   Interest on long-term debt
  

 

 

   
     21     Income before income taxes
     (7   Applicable income tax expense
  

 

 

   
     14     Net income
  

 

 

   

Net periodic benefit costs

    

Amortization of net actuarial loss

     (3   Employee benefits expense (a)
  

 

 

   
     (3   Income before income taxes
     1     Applicable income tax expense
  

 

 

   
     (2   Net income
  

 

 

   

Total reclassifications for the period

   $ 7     Net income
  

 

 

   

 

(a) This AOCI component is included in the computation of net periodic benefit cost. Refer to Note 21 in the Bancorp’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013 for information on the computation of net periodic benefit cost.
(b) Amounts in parentheses indicate reductions to net income.

 

92


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

18. Earnings Per Share

The calculation of earnings per share and the reconciliation of earnings per share and earnings per diluted share were as follows:

 

     2014      2013  

For the three months ended March 31,

(in millions, except per share data)

   Income      Average
Shares
     Per Share
Amount
     Income      Average
Shares
     Per Share
Amount
 

Earnings per share:

                 

Net income attributable to Bancorp

   $ 318              422        

Dividends on preferred stock

     9              9        
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income available to common shareholders

     309              413        

Less: Income allocated to participating securities

     3              3        
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income allocated to common shareholders

   $ 306        846        0.36        410        871        0.47  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Earnings per diluted share:

                 

Net income available to common shareholders

   $ 309              413        

Effect of dilutive securities:

                 

Stock-based awards

     —          12           —          6     

Series G convertible preferred stock

     —          —             9        36     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income available to common shareholders

     309              422        

plus assumed conversions

                 

Less: Income allocated to participating securities

     3              3        
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income allocated to common shareholders plus assumed conversions

   $ 306        858        0.36        419        913        0.46  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Shares are excluded from the computation of net income per diluted share when their inclusion has an anti-dilutive effect on earnings per share. The diluted earnings per share computation for the three months ended March 31, 2014 excludes 11 million of stock appreciation rights and an immaterial amount of stock options. The diluted earnings per share computation for the three months ended March 31, 2013 excludes 27 million of stock appreciation rights and 3 million of stock options.

The diluted earnings per share computation for the three months ended March 31, 2013 excludes the impact of the forward contract related to the January 28, 2013 accelerated share repurchase transaction. Based upon the average daily volume weighted average price of the Bancorp’s common stock during the first quarter of 2013, the counterparty to the transaction would have been required to deliver approximately 1 million shares as of March 31, 2013, and thus the impact of the accelerated share repurchase transaction would have been anti-dilutive to earnings per share.

 

93


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

19. Fair Value Measurements

The Bancorp measures certain financial assets and liabilities at fair value in accordance with U.S. GAAP, which defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. U.S. GAAP also establishes a fair value hierarchy, which prioritizes the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value into three broad levels. The fair value hierarchy gives the highest priority to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (Level 1) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs (Level 3). A financial instrument’s categorization within the fair value hierarchy is based upon the lowest level of input that is significant to the instrument’s fair value measurement. For more information regarding the fair value hierarchy, see Note 1 in the Bancorp’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013.

Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis

The following tables summarize assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis, including residential mortgage loans held for sale for which the Bancorp has elected the fair value option as of:

 

      Fair Value Measurements Using         

March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

   Level 1(c)       Level 2(c)       Level 3      Total Fair Value  

Assets:

           

Available-for-sale securities:

           

U.S. Treasury and government agencies

   $ 26        —          —          26  

U.S. Government sponsored agencies

     —          1,635        —          1,635  

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

     —          194        —          194  

Agency mortgage-backed securities

     —          14,185        —          14,185  

Other bonds, notes and debentures

     —          3,991        —          3,991  

Other securities(a)

     85        34        —          119  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Available-for-sale securities(a)

     111        20,039        —          20,150  

Trading securities:

           

U.S. Government sponsored agencies

     —          5        —          5  

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

     —          14        1        15  

Agency mortgage-backed securities

     —          3        —          3  

Other bonds, notes and debentures

     —          10        —          10  

Other securities

     314        —          —          314  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trading securities

     314        32        1        347  

Residential mortgage loans held for sale

     —          649        —          649  

Residential mortgage loans(b)

     —          —          103        103  

Derivative assets:

           

Interest rate contracts

     2        818        16        836  

Foreign exchange contracts

     —          204        —          204  

Equity contracts

     —          —          348        348  

Commodity contracts

     10        56        —          66  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Derivative assets

     12        1,078        364        1,454  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 437        21,798        468        22,703  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities:

           

Derivative liabilities:

           

Interest rate contracts

   $ 1        344        3        348  

Foreign exchange contracts

     —          164        —          164  

Equity contracts

     —          —          43        43  

Commodity contracts

     17        51        —          68  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Derivative liabilities

     18        559        46        623  

Short positions

     9        2        —          11  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities

   $ 27        561        46        634  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

94


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

     Fair Value Measurements Using         

December 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

   Level 1(c)      Level 2(c)      Level 3      Total Fair Value  

Assets:

           

Available-for-sale securities:

           

U.S. Treasury and Government agencies

   $ 26        —          —          26  

U.S. Government sponsored agencies

     —          1,644        —          1,644  

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

     —          192        —          192  

Agency mortgage-backed securities

     —          12,284        —          12,284  

Other bonds, notes and debentures

     —          3,582        —          3,582  

Other securities(a)

     89        29        —          118  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Available-for-sale securities(a)

     115        17,731        —          17,846  

Trading securities:

           

U.S. Treasury and Government agencies

     1        —          —          1  

U.S. Government sponsored agencies

     —          4        —          4  

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

     —          12        1        13  

Agency mortgage-backed securities

     —          3        —          3  

Other bonds, notes and debentures

     —          7        —          7  

Other securities

     315        —          —          315  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trading securities

     316        26        1        343  

Residential mortgage loans held for sale

     —          890        —          890  

Residential mortgage loans(b)

     —          —          92        92  

Derivative assets:

           

Interest rate contracts

     13        802        12        827  

Foreign exchange contracts

     —          276        —          276  

Equity contracts

     —          —          384        384  

Commodity contracts

     18        48        —          66  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Derivative assets

     31        1,126        396        1,553  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 462        19,773        489        20,724  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities:

           

Derivative liabilities:

           

Interest rate contracts

   $ 1        384        4        389  

Foreign exchange contracts

     —          252        —          252  

Equity contracts

     —          —          48        48  

Commodity contracts

     9        56        —          65  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Derivative liabilities

     10        692        52        754  

Short positions

     4        4        —          8  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities

   $ 14        696        52        762  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Excludes FHLB and FRB restricted stock totaling $249 and $350, respectively, at March 31, 2014 and $402 and $349 at December 31, 2013, respectively.
(b) Includes residential mortgage loans originated as held for sale and subsequently transferred to held for investment.
(c) During the three months ended March 31, 2014 and the year ended December 31, 2013, no assets or liabilities were transferred between Level 1 and Level 2.

The following is a description of the valuation methodologies used for significant instruments measured at fair value, as well as the general classification of such instruments pursuant to the valuation hierarchy.

Available-for-sale and trading securities

Where quoted prices are available in an active market, securities are classified within Level 1 of the valuation hierarchy. Level 1 securities include government bonds and exchange traded equities. If quoted market prices are not available, then fair values are estimated using pricing models, quoted prices of securities with similar characteristics, or discounted cash flows. Examples of such instruments, which are classified within Level 2 of the valuation hierarchy, include agency and non-agency mortgage-backed securities, other asset-backed securities, obligations of U.S. Government sponsored agencies, and corporate and municipal bonds. Corporate bonds are included in other bonds, notes and debentures in the previous table. Agency mortgage-backed securities, obligations of U.S. Government sponsored agencies, and corporate and municipal bonds are generally valued using a market approach based on observable prices of securities with similar characteristics.

Residential mortgage loans held for sale

For residential mortgage loans held for sale, fair value is estimated based upon mortgage-backed securities prices and spreads to those prices or, for certain ARM loans, DCF models that may incorporate the anticipated portfolio composition, credit spreads of asset-backed securities with similar collateral and market conditions. The anticipated portfolio composition includes the effect of interest rate spreads and discount rates due to loan characteristics such as the state in which the loan was originated, the loan amount and the ARM margin. Residential mortgage loans held for sale that are valued based on mortgage backed securities prices are classified within Level 2 of the valuation hierarchy as the valuation is based on external pricing for similar instruments. ARM loans classified as held for sale are also classified within Level 2 of the valuation hierarchy due to the use of observable inputs in the DCF model. These observable inputs include interest rate spreads from agency mortgage-backed securities market rates and observable discount rates.

 

95


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

Residential mortgage loans

Residential mortgage loans held for sale that are reclassified to held for investment are transferred from Level 2 to Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. It is the Bancorp’s policy to value any transfers between levels of the fair value hierarchy based on end of period fair values.

For residential mortgage loans reclassified from held for sale to held for investment, the fair value estimation is based on mortgage-backed securities prices, interest rate risk and an internally developed credit component. Therefore, these loans are classified within Level 3 of the valuation hierarchy. An adverse change in the loss rate or severity assumption would result in a decrease in fair value of the related loan. The Secondary Marketing Department, which reports to the Bancorp’s Chief Operating Officer, in conjunction with the Consumer Credit Risk Department, which reports to the Bancorp’s Chief Risk and Credit Officer, are responsible for determining the valuation methodology for residential mortgage loans held for investment. The Secondary Marketing Department reviews loss severity assumptions quarterly to determine if adjustments are necessary based on decreases in observable housing market data. This group also reviews trades in comparable benchmark securities and adjusts the values of loans as necessary. Consumer Credit Risk is responsible for the credit component of the fair value which is based on internally developed loss rate models that take into account historical loss rates and loss severities based on underlying collateral values.

Derivatives

Exchange-traded derivatives valued using quoted prices and certain over-the-counter derivatives valued using active bids are classified within Level 1 of the valuation hierarchy. Most of the Bancorp’s derivative contracts are valued using discounted cash flow or other models that incorporate current market interest rates, credit spreads assigned to the derivative counterparties and other market parameters and, therefore, are classified within Level 2 of the valuation hierarchy. Such derivatives include basic and structured interest rate swaps and options. Derivatives that are valued based upon models with significant unobservable market parameters are classified within Level 3 of the valuation hierarchy. At March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, derivatives classified as Level 3, which are valued using models containing unobservable inputs, consisted primarily of a warrant associated with the initial sale of the Bancorp’s 51% interest in Vantiv Holding, LLC to Advent International and a total return swap associated with the Bancorp’s sale of Visa, Inc. Class B shares. Level 3 derivatives also include interest rate lock commitments, which utilize internally generated loan closing rate assumptions as a significant unobservable input in the valuation process.

The warrant allows the Bancorp to purchase approximately 20 million incremental nonvoting units in Vantiv Holding, LLC under certain defined conditions involving change of control. The fair value of the warrant is calculated in conjunction with a third party valuation provider by applying Black-Scholes option valuation models using probability weighted scenarios which contain the following inputs: Vantiv, Inc. stock price, strike price per the Warrant Agreement and several unobservable inputs, such as expected term, expected volatility and expected dividend rate.

For the warrant, an increase in the expected term (years) and the expected volatility assumptions would result in an increase in the fair value; correspondingly, a decrease in these assumptions would result in a decrease in the fair value. The Accounting and Treasury Departments, both of which report to the Bancorp’s Chief Financial Officer, determined the valuation methodology for the warrant. Accounting and Treasury review changes in fair value on a quarterly basis for reasonableness based on changes in historical and implied volatilities, expected terms, probability weightings of the related scenarios, and other assumptions.

Under the terms of the total return swap, the Bancorp will make or receive payments based on subsequent changes in the conversion rate of the Visa, Inc. Class B shares into Class A shares. Additionally the Bancorp will make a quarterly payment based on Visa’s stock price and the conversion rate of the Visa, Inc. Class B shares into Class A shares until the date on which the Covered Litigation is settled. The fair value of the total return swap was calculated using a discounted cash flow model based on unobservable inputs consisting of management’s estimate of the probability of certain litigation scenarios, the timing of the resolution of the Covered Litigation and Visa litigation loss estimates in excess, or shortfall, of the Bancorp’s proportional share of escrow funds.

An increase in the loss estimate or a delay in the resolution of the Covered Litigation would result in an increase in fair value; correspondingly, a decrease in the loss estimate or an acceleration of the resolution of the Covered Litigation would result in a decrease in fair value. The Accounting and Treasury Departments determined the valuation methodology for the total return swap. Accounting and Treasury review the changes in fair value on a quarterly basis for reasonableness based on Visa stock price changes, litigation contingencies, and escrow funding.

The net fair value asset of the interest rate lock commitments at March 31, 2014 was $16 million. Immediate decreases in current interest rates of 25 bps and 50 bps would result in increases in the fair value of the interest rate lock commitments of approximately $9 million and $16 million, respectively. Immediate increases of current interest rates of 25 bps and 50 bps would result in decreases in the fair value of the interest rate lock commitments of approximately $9 million and $19 million, respectively. The decrease in fair value of interest rate lock commitments due to immediate 10% and 20% adverse changes in the assumed loan closing rates would be approximately $2 million and $3 million, respectively, and the increase in fair value due to immediate 10% and 20% favorable changes in the assumed loan closing rates would be approximately $2 million and $3 million, respectively. These sensitivities are hypothetical and should be used with caution, as changes in fair value based on a variation in assumptions typically cannot be extrapolated because the relationship of the change in assumptions to the change in fair value may not be linear.

The Secondary Marketing Department and the Consumer Line of Business Finance Department, which reports to the Bancorp’s Chief Financial Officer, are responsible for determining the valuation methodology for IRLCs. Secondary Marketing, in conjunction with a third party valuation provider, periodically review loan closing rate assumptions and recent loan sales to determine if adjustments are needed for current market conditions not reflected in historical data.

 

96


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

The following tables are a reconciliation of assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3):

 

      Fair Value Measurements Using Significant Unobservable Inputs (Level  3)  

For the three months ended March 31, 2014

($ in millions)

   Trading
Securities
     Residential
Mortgage
Loans
    Interest Rate
Derivatives,
Net
(a)
    Equity
Derivatives,
Net
(a)
    Total Fair
Value
 

Beginning balance

   $ 1        92       8       336       437  

Total gains or losses (realized/unrealized):

           

Included in earnings

     —          1       37       (35     3  

Settlements

     —          (2     (32     4       (30

Transfers into Level 3(b)

     —          12       —         —         12  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 1        103       13       305       422  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The amount of total gains or losses for the period included in earnings attributable to the change in unrealized gains or losses relating to assets still held at March 31, 2014(c)

   $ —          1       16       (35     (18
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     

 

 
     Fair Value Measurements Using Significant Unobservable Inputs (Level  3)  

For the three months ended March 31, 2013

($ in millions)

   Trading
Securities
     Residential
Mortgage
Loans
    Interest Rate
Derivatives,
Net
(a)
    Equity
Derivatives,
Net
(a)
    Total Fair
Value
 

Beginning balance

   $ 1        76       57       144       278  

Total gains or losses (realized/unrealized):

           

Included in earnings

     —          1       56       27       84  

Settlements

     —          (4     (65     3       (66

Transfers into Level 3(b)

     —          8       —         —         8  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 1        81       48       174       304  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The amount of total gains or losses for the period included in earnings attributable to the change in unrealized gains or losses relating to assets still held at March 31, 2013(c)

   $ —          1       51       27       79  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Net interest rate derivatives include derivative assets and liabilities of $16 and $3, respectively, as of March 31, 2014 and $51 and $3, respectively, as of March 31, 2013. Net equity derivatives include derivative assets and liabilities of $348 and $43, respectively, as of March 31, 2014, and $211 and $37, respectively, as of March 31, 2013.
(b) Includes residential mortgage loans held for sale that were transferred to held for investment.
(c) Includes interest income and expense.

The total gains and losses included in earnings for assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) were recorded in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income as follows:

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Mortgage banking net revenue

   $ 38       57  

Other noninterest income

     (35     27  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total gains

   $ 3       84  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The total gains and losses included in earnings attributable to changes in unrealized gains and losses related to Level 3 assets and liabilities still held at March 31, 2014 and 2013 were recorded in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income as follows:

 

     For the three months
ended March 31,
 

($ in millions)

   2014     2013  

Mortgage banking net revenue

   $ 17       52  

Other noninterest income

     (35     27  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total (losses) gains

   $ (18     79  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

97


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

The following tables present information as of March 31, 2014 and 2013 about significant unobservable inputs related to the Bancorp’s material categories of Level 3 financial assets and liabilities measured on a recurring basis:

 

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

                             

Financial Instrument

   Fair Value    

Valuation Technique

  

Significant Unobservable Inputs

   Ranges of Inputs      Weighted-
Average
 

Residential mortgage loans

   $ 103     Loss rate model   

Interest rate risk factor

Credit risk factor

    

 

(21.8) - 20.1%

0 - 62.4%

  

  

    

 

3.0%

2.0%

  

  

  

 

 

         

 

 

    

 

 

 

IRLCs, net

     16     Discounted cash flow    Loan closing rates      7.3 - 95.0%         67.6%   
  

 

 

         

 

 

    

 

 

 

Stock warrant associated with Vantiv Holding, LLC

     348    

Black-Scholes

option valuation model

  

Expected term (years)

Expected volatility(a)

Expected dividend rate

    

 

 

2.00 - 15.25  

25.0 - 32.7%

—  

  

  

  

    

 
 

6.0  

28.1%
—  

 

  
  

  

 

 

         

 

 

    

 

 

 

Swap associated with the sale of Visa, Inc. Class B shares

     (43   Discounted cash flow   

Timing of the resolution

of the Covered Litigation

    

 

12/31/2014 - 

12/31/2019

  

  

     NM   
  

 

 

         

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of March 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

                             

Financial Instrument

   Fair Value    

Valuation Technique

  

Significant Unobservable Inputs

   Ranges of Inputs      Weighted-
Average
 

Residential mortgage loans

   $ 81     Loss rate model   

Interest rate risk factor

Credit risk factor

    

 

(91.0) - 49.0%

0 - 68.4%

  

  

    

 

6.0%

3.4%

  

  

  

 

 

         

 

 

    

 

 

 

IRLCs, net

     50     Discounted cash flow    Loan closing rates      9.9 - 95.0%         65.8%   
  

 

 

         

 

 

    

 

 

 

Stock warrant associated with Vantiv Holding, LLC

     211     Black-Scholes option valuation model   

Expected term (years)

Expected volatility(a)

Expected dividend rate

    
 

 

2.00 - 16.50  
23.6 - 35.0%

—  

  
  

 

    

 
 

5.1  

28.9%
—  

 

  
 

  

 

 

         

 

 

    

 

 

 

Swap associated with the sale of Visa, Inc. Class B shares

     (37   Discounted cash flow   

Timing of the resolution

of the Covered Litigation

    

 

3/31/2014 - 

3/31/2017

  

  

     NM   
  

 

 

         

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Based on historical and implied volatilities of Vantiv, Inc. and comparable companies assuming similar expected terms.

Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Nonrecurring Basis

Certain assets and liabilities are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis. These assets and liabilities are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis; however, they are subject to fair value adjustments in certain circumstances, such as when there is evidence of impairment.

The following tables represent those assets that were subject to fair value adjustments during the quarters ended March 31, 2014 and 2013 and still held as of the end of the period, and the related losses from fair value adjustments on assets sold during the period as well as assets still held as of the end of the period:

 

     Fair Value Measurements Using             Total Losses  

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

   Level 1      Level 2      Level 3      Total      For the three months
ended March 31, 2014
 

Commercial loans held for sale(a)

   $ —           —           —           —           —     

Commercial and industrial loans

     —          —          22        22        (41

Commercial mortgage loans

     —          —          31        31        (11

Commercial construction loans

     —          —          2        2        —    

MSRs

     —          —          972        972        4  

OREO

     —          —          95        95        (13
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ —          —          1,122        1,122        (61
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     Fair Value Measurements Using             Total Losses  

As of March 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

   Level 1      Level 2      Level 3      Total      For the three months
ended March 31, 2013
 

Commercial loans held for sale(a)

   $ —          —          4        4        (4

Commercial and industrial loans

     —          —          20        20        (6

Commercial mortgage loans

     —          —          34        34        (17

Commercial construction loans

     —          —          7        7        —    

MSRs

     —          —          766        766        49  

OREO

     —          —          120        120        (22
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ —          —          951        951        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Includes commercial nonaccrual loans held for sale.

 

98


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

The following tables present information as of March 31, 2014 and 2013 about significant unobservable inputs related to the Bancorp’s material categories of Level 3 financial assets and liabilities measured on a nonrecurring basis:

 

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

                              

Financial Instrument

   Fair Value     

Valuation Technique

  

Significant

Unobservable Inputs

   Ranges of
Inputs
     Weighted-Average  

Commercial loans held for sale

   $ —        Appraised value    Appraised value      NM         NM   
         Cost to sell      NM         10.0%   
  

 

 

          

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial loans

     22      Appraised value    Collateral value      NM         NM   
  

 

 

          

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commercial mortgage loans

     31      Appraised value    Collateral value      NM         NM   
  

 

 

          

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commercial construction loans

     2      Appraised value    Collateral value      NM         NM   
  

 

 

          

 

 

    

 

 

 

MSRs

     972      Discounted cash flow    Prepayment speed      0 - 100%        

 

(Fixed) 10.6%

(Adjustable) 26.1%

  

  

         Discount rates      9.6 - 13.2%        

 

(Fixed) 9.9%

(Adjustable) 11.8%

  

  

  

 

 

          

 

 

    

 

 

 

OREO

     95      Appraised value    Appraised value      NM         NM   
  

 

 

          

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of March 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

                              

Financial Instrument

   Fair Value     

Valuation Technique

  

Significant
Unobservable Inputs

   Ranges of
Inputs
     Weighted-Average  

Commercial loans held for sale

   $ 4      Appraised value    Appraised value      NM         NM   
         Cost to sell      NM         10.0%   
  

 

 

          

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial loans

     20      Appraised value    Default rates      100%         NM   
         Collateral value      NM         NM   
  

 

 

          

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commercial mortgage loans

     34      Appraised value    Default rates      100%         NM   
         Collateral value      NM         NM   
  

 

 

          

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commercial construction loans

     7      Appraised value    Default rates      100%         NM   
         Collateral value      NM         NM   
  

 

 

          

 

 

    

 

 

 

MSRs

     766      Discounted cash flow    Prepayment speed      0 - 100%        

 

(Fixed) 14.0%

(Adjustable) 26.8%

  

  

         Discount rates      9.4 - 18.0%        

 

(Fixed) 10.5%

(Adjustable) 11.7%

  

  

  

 

 

          

 

 

    

 

 

 

OREO

     120      Appraised value    Appraised value      NM         NM   
  

 

 

          

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commercial loans held for sale

During the first quarter of 2014, the Bancorp did not transfer any commercial loans from the portfolio to loans held for sale that upon transfer were measured at fair value. During the first quarter of 2013, the Bancorp transferred $3 million of commercial loans from the portfolio to loans held for sale that upon transfer were measured at fair value using significant unobservable inputs. There were no fair value adjustments for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and $3 million of fair value adjustments for the three months ended March 31, 2013 that were generally based on appraisals of the underlying collateral and were therefore, classified within Level 3 of the valuation hierarchy. Additionally, there were immaterial fair value adjustments on existing commercial loans held for sale for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and $1 million for the three months ended March 31, 2013. The fair value adjustments are also based on appraisals of the underlying collateral and were therefore classified within Level 3 of the valuation hierarchy. An adverse change in the fair value of the underlying collateral would result in a decrease in the fair value measurement. The Accounting Department determines the procedures for valuation of commercial held for sale loans which may include a comparison to recently executed transactions of similar type loans. A monthly review of the portfolio is performed for reasonableness. Quarterly, appraisals approaching a year-old are updated and the Real Estate Valuation group, which reports to the Chief Risk and Credit Officer, in conjunction with the Commercial Line of Business review the third party appraisals for reasonableness. Additionally, the Commercial Line of Business Finance Department, which reports to the Bancorp Chief Financial Officer, in conjunction with Accounting review all loan appraisal values, carrying values and vintages.

Commercial loans held for investment

During the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, the Bancorp recorded nonrecurring impairment adjustments to certain commercial and industrial, commercial mortgage and commercial construction loans held for investment. Larger commercial loans included within aggregate borrower relationship balances exceeding $1 million that exhibit probable or observed credit weaknesses are subject to individual review for impairment. The Bancorp considers the current value of collateral, credit quality of any guarantees, the guarantor’s liquidity and willingness to cooperate, the loan structure and other factors when evaluating whether an individual loan is impaired. When the loan is collateral dependent, the fair value of the loan is generally based on the fair value of the underlying collateral supporting the loan and therefore these loans were classified within Level 3 of the valuation hierarchy. In cases where the carrying value exceeds the fair value, an impairment loss is recognized.

An adverse change in the fair value of the underlying collateral would result in a decrease in the fair value measurement. The fair values and recognized impairment losses are reflected in the previous table. Commercial Credit Risk, which reports to the Chief Risk and Credit Officer, is responsible for preparing and reviewing the fair value estimates for commercial loans held for investment.

 

99


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

Mortgage servicing rights

MSRs do not trade in an active, open market with readily observable prices. While sales of MSRs do occur, the precise terms and conditions typically are not readily available. Accordingly, the Bancorp estimates the fair value of MSRs using internal discounted cash flow models with certain unobservable inputs, primarily prepayment speed assumptions, discount rates and weighted average lives, resulting in a classification within Level 3 of the valuation hierarchy. Refer to Note 9 for further information on the assumptions used in the valuation of the Bancorp’s MSRs. The Secondary Marketing Department and Treasury Department are responsible for determining the valuation methodology for MSRs. Representatives from Secondary Marketing, Treasury, Accounting and Risk Management are responsible for reviewing key assumptions used in the internal discounted cash flow model. Two external valuations of the MSR portfolio are obtained from third parties that use valuation models in order to assess the reasonableness of the internal discounted cash flow model. Additionally, the Bancorp participates in peer surveys that provide additional confirmation of the reasonableness of key assumptions utilized in the MSR valuation process and the resulting MSR prices.

OREO

During the three months ended March 31, 2014, the Bancorp recorded nonrecurring adjustments to certain commercial and residential real estate properties classified as OREO and measured at the lower of carrying amount or fair value. These nonrecurring losses are primarily due to declines in real estate values of the properties recorded in OREO. These losses include $3 million and $12 million in losses, recorded as charge-offs, on new OREO properties transferred from loans during the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and $10 million in losses for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013, recorded as negative fair value adjustments on OREO in other noninterest income subsequent to their transfer from loans. As discussed in the following paragraphs, the fair value amounts are generally based on appraisals of the property values, resulting in a classification within Level 3 of the valuation hierarchy. In cases where the carrying amount exceeds the fair value, less costs to sell, an impairment loss is recognized. The previous tables reflect the fair value measurements of the properties before deducting the estimated costs to sell.

The Real Estate Valuation department, which reports to the Chief Risk and Credit Officer, is solely responsible for managing the appraisal process and evaluating the appraisal for all commercial properties transferred to OREO. All appraisals on commercial OREO properties are updated on at least an annual basis.

The Real Estate Valuation department reviews the BPO data and internal market information to determine the initial charge-off on residential real estate loans transferred to OREO. Once the foreclosure process is completed, the Bancorp performs an interior inspection to update the initial fair value of the property. These properties are reviewed at least every 30 days after the initial interior inspections are completed. The Asset Manager receives a monthly status report for each property which includes the number of showings, recently sold properties, current comparable listings and overall market conditions.

Fair Value Option

The Bancorp elected to measure certain residential mortgage loans held for sale under the fair value option as allowed under U.S. GAAP. Electing to measure residential mortgage loans held for sale at fair value reduces certain timing differences and better matches changes in the value of these assets with changes in the value of derivatives used as economic hedges for these assets. Management’s intent to sell residential mortgage loans classified as held for sale may change over time due to such factors as changes in the overall liquidity in markets or changes in characteristics specific to certain loans held for sale. Consequently, these loans may be reclassified to loans held for investment and maintained in the Bancorp’s loan portfolio. In such cases, the loans will continue to be measured at fair value.

Fair value changes recognized in earnings for instruments held at March 31, 2014 and 2013 for which the fair value option was elected as well as the changes in fair value of the underlying IRLCs, included gains of $23 million and $114 million, respectively. These gains are reported in mortgage banking net revenue in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income.

Valuation adjustments related to instrument-specific credit risk for residential mortgage loans measured at fair value negatively impacted the fair value of those loans by $2 million at March 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013. Interest on residential mortgage loans measured at fair value is accrued as it is earned using the effective interest method and is reported as interest income in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income.

 

100


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

The following table summarizes the difference between the fair value and the principal balance for residential mortgage loans measured at fair value as of:

 

     Aggregate      Aggregate Unpaid         

($ in millions)

   Fair Value      Principal Balance      Difference  

March 31, 2014

        

Residential mortgage loans measured at fair value

   $ 752        729        23  

Past due loans of 90 days or more

     2        2        —    

Nonaccrual loans

     3        3        —    

December 31, 2013

        

Residential mortgage loans measured at fair value

     982        962        20  

Past due loans of 90 days or more

     1        2        (1

Nonaccrual loans

     2        2        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fair Value of Certain Financial Instruments

The following tables summarize the carrying amounts and estimated fair values for certain financial instruments, excluding financial instruments measured at fair value on a recurring basis:

 

 

As of March 31, 2014 ($ in millions)

   Net Carrying
Amount
    Fair Value Measurements Using      Total
Fair Value
 
     Level 1      Level 2      Level 3     

Financial assets:

             

Cash and due from banks

   $ 3,153       3,153        —          —          3,153  

Other securities

     599       —          599        —          599  

Held-to-maturity securities

     195       —          —          195        195  

Other short-term investments

     2,202       2,202        —          —          2,202  

Loans held for sale

     131       —          —          131        131  

Portfolio loans and leases:

             

Commercial and industrial loans

     39,872       —          —          41,192        41,192  

Commercial mortgage loans

     7,767       —          —          7,365        7,365  

Commercial construction loans

     1,195       —          —          1,015        1,015  

Commercial leases

     3,529       —          —          3,270        3,270  

Residential mortgage loans

     12,343       —          —          11,841        11,841  

Home equity

     9,039       —          —          9,081        9,081  

Automobile loans

     12,060       —          —          11,818        11,818  

Credit card

     2,087       —          —          2,263        2,263  

Other consumer loans and leases

     332       —          —          342        342  

Unallocated allowance for loan and lease losses

     (105     —          —          —          —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total portfolio loans and leases, net

   $ 88,119       —          —          88,187        88,187  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial liabilities:

             

Deposits

     96,874       —          96,893        —          96,893  

Federal funds purchased

     268       268        —          —          268  

Other short-term borrowings

     2,717       —          2,718        —          2,718  

Long-term debt

     11,233       11,257        606        —          11,863  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

101


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2013 ($ in millions)

   Net Carrying
Amount
    Fair Value Measurements Using      Fair Value  
     Level 1      Level 2      Level 3     

Financial assets:

             

Cash and due from banks

   $ 3,178       3,178        —          —          3,178  

Other securities

     751       —          751        —          751  

Held-to-maturity securities

     208       —          —          208        208  

Other short-term investments

     5,116       5,116        —          —          5,116  

Loans held for sale

     54       —          —          54        54  

Portfolio loans and leases:

             

Commercial and industrial loans

     38,549       —          —          39,804        39,804  

Commercial mortgage loans

     7,854       —          —          7,430        7,430  

Commercial construction loans

     1,013       —          —          856        856  

Commercial leases

     3,572       —          —          3,261        3,261  

Residential mortgage loans

     12,399       —          —          11,541        11,541  

Home equity

     9,152       —          —          9,181        9,181  

Automobile loans

     11,961       —          —          11,748        11,748  

Credit card

     2,202       —          —          2,380        2,380  

Other consumer loans and leases

     348       —          —          361        361  

Unallocated allowance for loan and lease losses

     (110     —          —          —          —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total portfolio loans and leases, net

   $ 86,940       —          —          86,562        86,562  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial liabilities:

             

Deposits

     99,275       —          99,288        —          99,288  

Federal funds purchased

     284       284        —          —          284  

Other short-term borrowings

     1,380       —          1,380        —          1,380  

Long-term debt

     9,633       9,645        577        —          10,222  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash and due from banks, other securities, other short-term investments, deposits, federal funds purchased and other short-term borrowings

For financial instruments with a short-term or no stated maturity, prevailing market rates and limited credit risk, carrying amounts approximate fair value. Those financial instruments include cash and due from banks, FHLB and FRB restricted stock, other short-term investments, certain deposits (demand, interest checking, savings, money market and foreign office deposits), federal funds purchased, and other short-term borrowings excluding FHLB borrowings. Fair values for other time deposits, certificates of deposit $100,000 and over and FHLB borrowings were estimated using a discounted cash flow calculation that applies prevailing LIBOR/swap rates and a spread for new issuances with similar terms.

Held-to-maturity securities

The Bancorp’s held-to-maturity securities are primarily composed of instruments that provide income tax credits as the economic return on the investment. The fair value of these instruments is estimated based on current U.S. Treasury tax credit rates.

Loans held for sale

Fair values for commercial loans held for sale were valued based on executable bids when available, or on discounted cash flow models incorporating appraisals of the underlying collateral, as well as assumptions about investor return requirements and amounts and timing of expected cash flows. Fair values for other consumer loans held for sale are based on contractual values upon which the loans may be sold to a third party, and approximate their carrying value.

Portfolio loans and leases, net

Fair values were estimated by discounting future cash flows using the current market rates of loans to borrowers with similar credit characteristics, similar remaining maturities, prepayment speeds, and loss severities.

Long-term debt

Fair value of long-term debt was based on quoted market prices, when available, or a discounted cash flow calculation using LIBOR/swap interest rates and, in some cases, Fifth Third credit and/or debt instrument spreads for new issuances with similar terms.

 

102


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

20. Business Segments

The Bancorp reports on four business segments: Commercial Banking, Branch Banking, Consumer Lending and Investment Advisors. Results of the Bancorp’s business segments are presented based on its management structure and management accounting practices. The structure and accounting practices are specific to the Bancorp; therefore, the financial results of the Bancorp’s business segments are not necessarily comparable with similar information for other financial institutions. The Bancorp refines its methodologies from time to time as management’s accounting practices are improved and businesses change.

The Bancorp manages interest rate risk centrally at the corporate level by employing an FTP methodology. This methodology insulates the business segments from interest rate volatility, enabling them to focus on serving customers through loan originations and deposit taking. The FTP system assigns charge rates and credit rates to classes of assets and liabilities, respectively, based on expected duration and the U.S. swap curve. Matching duration allocates interest income and interest expense to each segment so its resulting net interest income is insulated from interest rate risk. In a rising rate environment, the Bancorp benefits from the widening spread between deposit costs and wholesale funding costs. However, the Bancorp’s FTP system credits this benefit to deposit-providing businesses, such as Branch Banking and Investment Advisors, on a duration-adjusted basis. The net impact of the FTP methodology is captured in General Corporate and Other.

The Bancorp adjusts the FTP charge and credit rates as dictated by changes in interest rates for various interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities and by the review of the estimated durations for the indeterminate-lived deposits. The credit rate provided for demand deposit accounts is reviewed annually based upon the account type, its estimated duration and the corresponding fed funds, U.S. swap curve or swap rate. The credit rates for several deposit products were reset January 1, 2014 to reflect the current market rates and updated market assumptions. These rates were generally higher than those in place during 2013, thus net interest income for deposit providing businesses was positively impacted during 2014.

The business segments are charged provision expense based on the actual net charge-offs experienced by the loans and leases owned by each segment. Provision expense attributable to loan and leases growth and changes in ALLL factors are captured in General Corporate and Other. The financial results of the business segments include allocations for shared services and headquarters expenses. Even with these allocations, the financial results are not necessarily indicative of the business segments’ financial condition and results of operations as if they existed as independent entities. Additionally, the business segments form synergies by taking advantage of cross-sell opportunities and when funding operations, by accessing the capital markets as a collective unit.

The results of operations and financial position for the three months ended March 31, 2013 were restated to reflect the transfer of certain customers and Bancorp employees from Branch Banking to Commercial Banking, effective January 1, 2014. In addition, the prior year balances were restated to reflect a change in internal allocation methodology.

The following is a description of each of the Bancorp’s business segments, and the products and services they provide to their respective client bases.

Commercial Banking offers credit intermediation, cash management and financial services to large and middle-market businesses and government and professional customers. In addition to the traditional lending and depository offerings, Commercial Banking products and services include global cash management, foreign exchange and international trade finance, derivatives and capital markets services, asset-based lending, real estate finance, public finance, commercial leasing and syndicated finance.

Branch Banking provides a full range of deposit and loan and lease products to individuals and small businesses through 1,311 full-service Banking Centers. Branch Banking offers depository and loan products, such as checking and savings accounts, home equity loans and lines of credit, credit cards and loans for automobiles and other personal financing needs, as well as products designed to meet the specific needs of small businesses, including cash management services.

Consumer Lending includes the Bancorp’s mortgage, home equity, automobile and other indirect lending activities. Mortgage and home equity lending activities include the origination, retention and servicing of mortgage, automobile and home equity loans or lines of credit, sales and securitizations of those loans, pools of loans or lines of credit, and all associated hedging activities. Indirect lending activities include extending loans to consumers through mortgage brokers and automobile dealers.

Investment Advisors provides a full range of investment alternatives for individuals, companies and not-for-profit organizations. Investment Advisors is made up of four main businesses: FTS, an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of the Bancorp; ClearArc Capital, Inc., an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of the Bancorp; Fifth Third Private Bank; and Fifth Third Institutional Services. FTS offers full service retail brokerage services to individual clients and broker dealer services to the institutional marketplace. ClearArc Capital, Inc. provides asset management services and previously advised the Bancorp’s proprietary family of mutual funds. Fifth Third Private Bank offers holistic strategies to affluent clients in wealth planning, investing, insurance and wealth protection. Fifth Third Institutional Services provides advisory services for institutional clients including states and municipalities.

 

103


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

Results of operations and assets by segment for the three months ended March 31, 2014 and 2013 are:

 

                                General              
     Commercial      Branch      Consumer     Investment      Corporate              

($ in millions)

   Banking      Banking      Lending     Advisors      and Other     Eliminations     Total  

Three months ended March 31, 2014

                 

Net interest income

   $ 404        385        64       32        8       —         893  

Provision for loan and lease losses

     97        45        25       —          (98     —         69  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for loan and lease losses

     307        340        39       32        106       —         824  

Noninterest income:

                 

Service charges on deposits

     69        63        —         1        —         —         133  

Mortgage banking net revenue

     —          1        108       —          —         —         109  

Corporate banking revenue

     104        1        —         1        (2     —         104  

Investment advisory revenue

     1        36        —         100        —         (35 )(a)       102  

Card and processing revenue

     16        51        —         1        —         —         68  

Other noninterest income

     20        20        10       —          (9     —         41  

Securities gains, net

     —          —          —         —          7       —         7  

Securities gains, net - non-qualifying hedges on mortgage servicing rights

     —          —          —         —          —         —         —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total noninterest income

     210        172        118       103        (4     (35     564  

Noninterest expense:

                 

Salaries, wages and incentives

     64        105        25       34        131       —         359  

Employee benefits

     19        35        9       9        29       —         101  

Net occupancy expense

     6        46        2       2        24       —         80  

Technology and communications

     3        2        —         —          48       —         53  

Card and processing expense

     2        29        —         —          —         —         31  

Equipment expense

     2        15        —         —          13       —         30  

Other noninterest expense

     238        158        130       65        (260     (35     296  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total noninterest expense

     334        390        166       110        (15     (35     950  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

     183        122        (9     25        117       —         438  

Applicable income tax expense (benefit)

     19        42        (3     8        53       —         119  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

     164        80        (6     17        64       —         319  

Less: Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests

     —          —          —         —          1       —         1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to Bancorp

     164        80        (6     17        63       —         318  

Dividends on preferred stock

     —          —          —         —          9       —         9  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) available to common shareholders

   $ 164        80        (6     17        54       —         309  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total goodwill

   $ 613        1,655        —         148        —         —         2,416  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 55,676        48,888        22,436       9,775        (7,121     —         129,654  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Revenue sharing agreements between Investment Advisors and Branch Banking are eliminated in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income.

 

104


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

                                 General              
     Commercial      Branch      Consumer      Investment      Corporate              

($ in millions)

   Banking      Banking      Lending      Advisors      and Other     Eliminations     Total  

Three months ended March 31, 2013

                  

Net interest income

   $ 384        323        85        36        60       —         888  

Provision for loan and lease losses

     44        57        29        1        (69     —         62  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for loan and lease losses

     340        266        56        35        129       —         826  

Noninterest income:

                  

Service charges on deposits

     65        65        —          1        —         —         131  

Mortgage banking net revenue

     —          4        216        —          —         —         220  

Corporate banking revenue

     97        1        —          1        —         —         99  

Investment advisory revenue

     1        37        —          98        —         (36 )(a)       100  

Card and processing revenue

     15        49        —          1        —         —         65  

Other noninterest income

     16        22        11        7        53       —         109  

Securities gains, net

     —          —          —          —          17       —         17  

Securities gains, net - non-qualifying hedges on mortgage servicing rights

     —          —          2        —          —         —         2  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total noninterest income

     194        178        229        108        70       (36     743  

Noninterest expense:

                  

Salaries, wages and incentives

     70        109        50        33        137       —         399  

Employee benefits

     20        36        13        9        36       —         114  

Net occupancy expense

     6        46        2        3        22       —         79  

Technology and communications

     3        1        —          —          45       —         49  

Card and processing expense

     1        29        —          —          1       —         31  

Equipment expense

     1        14        —          —          13       —         28  

Other noninterest expense

     199        155        112        70        (222     (36     278  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total noninterest expense

     300        390        177        115        32       (36     978  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income before income taxes

     234        54        108        28        167       —         591  

Applicable income tax expense

     36        20        38        10        75       —         179  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

     198        34        70        18        92       —         412  

Less: Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests

     —          —          —          —          (10     —         (10
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income attributable to Bancorp

     198        34        70        18        102       —         422  

Dividends on preferred stock

     —          —          —          —          9       —         9  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income available to common shareholders

   $ 198        34        70        18        93       —         413  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total goodwill

   $ 613        1,655        —          148        —         —         2,416  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 52,117        47,527        24,026        9,114        (11,402     —         121,382  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Revenue sharing agreements between Investment Advisors and Branch Banking are eliminated in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income.

 

105


Table of Contents

Fifth Third Bancorp and Subsidiaries

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

 

 

21. Subsequent Events

On April 25, 2014, the Bank issued and sold $1.5 billion in aggregate principal amount of unsecured senior bank notes. The bank notes consisted of: $850 million of 2.375% senior fixed rate notes, with a maturity of five years, due on April 25, 2019 and $650 million of 1.35% senior fixed rate notes with a maturity of three years, due on June 1, 2017. These bank notes will be redeemable by the Bank, in whole or in part, on or after the date that is 30 days prior to the maturity date at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount plus accrued and unpaid interest up to, but excluding, the redemption date.

On April 28, 2014, the Bancorp entered into an accelerated share repurchase transaction with a counterparty pursuant to which the Bancorp purchased 6,216,480 shares, or approximately $150 million, of its outstanding common stock on May 1, 2014. The Bancorp repurchased the shares of its common stock as part of its Board approved 100 million share repurchase program previously announced on March 18, 2014. The Bancorp expects the settlement of the transaction to occur on or before July 28, 2014.

 

106


Table of Contents

PART II. OTHER INFORMATION

Legal Proceedings (Item 1)

Refer to Note 15 of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements in Part I, Item 1 for information regarding legal proceedings.

Risk Factors (Item 1A)

There have been no material changes made during the first quarter of 2014 to any of the risk factors as previously disclosed in the Registrant’s periodic securities filings.

Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds (Item 2)

Refer to the “Capital Management” section within Management’s Discussion and Analysis in Part I, Item 2 for information regarding purchases and sales of equity securities by the Bancorp during the first quarter of 2014.

Defaults Upon Senior Securities (Item 3)

None.

Mine Safety Disclosures (Item 4)

Not applicable.

Other Information (Item 5)

None.

Exhibits (Item 6)

 

  3.1 Amended Articles of Incorporation of Fifth Third Bancorp, as amended. Incorporated by reference to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013.

 

  3.2 Code of Regulations of Fifth Third Bancorp as Amended as of September 18, 2012. Incorporated by reference to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on September 21, 2012.

 

  4.1 Third Supplemental Indenture dated as of February 28, 2014 between Fifth Third Bancorp and Wilmington Trust Company, as Trustee, to the Indenture for Senior Debt Securities dated as of April 30, 2008 between Fifth Third Bancorp and the Trustee. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on February 28, 2014.

 

  4.2 Global Security dated as of February 28, 2014, representing Fifth Third Bancorp’s $500,000,000 in principal amount of its 2.30% Senior Notes due 2019. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 of the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on February 28, 2014.

 

  10.1 Master Confirmation, as supplemented by a Supplemental Confirmation, for accelerated share repurchase transaction dated January 28, 2014 between Fifth Third Bancorp and Deutsche Bank AG, London Branch.*

 

  10.2 Fifth Third Bancorp 2014 Incentive Compensation Plan. Incorporated by reference to the Registrant’s Proxy Statement dated March 6, 2014.**

 

  12.1 Computations of Consolidated Ratios of Earnings to Fixed Charges.

 

  12.2 Computations of Consolidated Ratios of Earnings to Combined Fixed Charges and Preferred Stock Dividend Requirements.

 

  31(i) Certification Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 by Chief Executive Officer.

 

  31(ii) Certification Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 by Chief Financial Officer.

 

  32(i) Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 by Chief Executive Officer.

 

  32(ii) Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 by Chief Financial Officer.

 

  101 Interactive data files pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T: (i) the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets, (ii) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income, (iii) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income, (iv) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Changes in Equity, (v) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows, and (vi) the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements tagged as blocks of text and in detail.*

 

* An application for confidential treatment for selected portions of this exhibit has been filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission.
** Denotes management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.

 

107


Table of Contents

Signatures

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

     

Fifth Third Bancorp

      Registrant
Date: May 8, 2014      

/s/ Tayfun Tuzun

      Tayfun Tuzun
      Executive Vice President and
      Chief Financial Officer

 

108